Title of Invention

PEPTIDOMIMETIC COMPOUNDS AND PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITIONS

Abstract A compound or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or prodrug such as herein described thereof, or a solvate of such a compound, its salt or its prodrug such as herein described.
Full Text Peptidomimetic Protease Inhibitors
This invention is directed to peptidomimetic compounds and intermediates thereto, their preparation including stereoselective synthetic processes to intermediates, pharmaceutical compositions containing the peptidomimetic compounds, and the use of the peptidomimetic compounds or compositions thereof as protease inhibitors, particularly as serine protease inhibitors, and more particularly as hepatitis C virus ("HCV") NS3 protease inhibitors. The peptidomimetic compounds, as HCV NS3 protease inhibitors, are particularly useful in interfering with the life cycle of the hepatitis C virus and in treating or preventing an HCV infection or physiological conditions associated therewith. The present invention is also directed to methods of combination therapy for inhibiting HCV replication in cells, or for treating or preventing an HCV infection in patients using the peptidomimetic compounds or pharmaceutical compositions, or kits and pharmaceutical packs therefor. According to the present invention included as pharmaceutical compositions are those comprising an inhibitor of HCV serine protease in combination with an interferon having anti-HCV activity; an inhibitor of HCV serine protease in combination with a compound, other than an interferon, having anti-HCV activity; or an inhibitor of HCV serine protease in combination with both an interferon having anti-HCV activity and a compound, other than an interferon, having anti-HCV activity. Further the present invention is directed to stereoselective methods for preparing chiral bicycloprolinate intermediates useful in the synthesis of the peptidomimetic compounds.
Background of the Invention
Infection by the HCV is a compelling human medical problem and is now recognized as the causative agent for most cases of non-A, non-B hepatitis.
The HCV is thought to infect chronically 3% of the world's population [A. Alberti et al., "Natural History of Hepatitis C," J. Hepatology. 31, (Suppl. 1), 17-24 (1999)]. In the United States alone the infection rate is 1.8% or 3.9 million people [MJ. Alter, "Hepatitis C Virus Infection in the United States," J. Hepatology. 31, (Suppl. 1), 88-91 (1999)]. Of all patients infected over 70% develop a chronic infection that is believed to be a major cause of cirrhosis and hepatocellular carcinoma. [D. Lavanchy, "Global Surveillance and Control of Hepatitis C," J. Viral Hepatitis, 6, 35-47 (1999)]
The replication of the HCV encompasses genomic encoding a polyprotein of 3010-3033 amino acids [Q.-L. Choo, et al., "Genetic Organization and Diversity of the Hepatitis C Virus", Proc. Nail. Acad. Sci. USA, 88.2451-2455 (1991); N. Kato et al., "Molecular Cloning of the

2
Human Hepatitis C Virus Genome From Japanese Patients with Non-A, Non-B Hepatitis", Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA. 82, 9524-9528 (1990); A. Takamizawa et al., "Structure and Organization of the Hepatitis C Virus Genome Isolated From Human Carriers", J. Virol., 65,1105-1113 (1991)]. The HCV nonstructural (NS) proteins are presumed to provide the essential catalytic machinery for viral replication. The NS proteins are derived by proteolytic cleavage of the polyprotein [R. Bartenschlager et al., "Nonstructural Protein 3 of the Hepatitis C Virus Encodes a Serine-Type Proteinase Required for Cleavage at the NS3/4 and NS4/5 Junctions", J. Virol., 67, 3835-3844 (1993); A. Grakoui et al. "Characterization of the Hepatitis C Virus-Encoded Serine Proteinase: Determination of Proteinase-Dependent Polyprotein Cleavage Sites", J. Virol., 62, 2832-2843 (1993); A. Grakoui et al., Expression and Identification of Hepatitis C Virus Polyprotein Cleavage Products", J. Virol.. 6J, 1385-1395 (1993); L. Tomei et al., "NS3 is a serine protease required for processing of hepatitis C virus polyprotein", J. Virol.. 67.4017-4026 (1993)]. In fact, it is the first 181 amino acids of NS3 (residues 1027-1207 of the viral polyprotein) have been shown to contain the serine protease domain of NS3 that processes all four downstream sites of the HCV polyprotein [C. Lin et al., "Hepatitis C Virus NS3 Serine Proteinase: Traits-Cleavage Requirements and Processing Kinetics", J. Virol.. 68, 8147-8157 (1994)].
The HCV NS protein 3 (NS3) contains a serine protease activity that helps in the processing of the majority of the viral enzymes, and thus is considered essential for viral replication and infectivity. The essentiality of the NS3 protease was inferred from the fact that mutations in the yellow fever virus NS3 protease decreases viral infectivity [T.J. Chambers et al., "Evidence that the N-terminal Domain of Nonstructural Protein NS3 From Yellow Fever Virus is a Serine Protease Responsible for Site-Specific Cleavages in the Viral Polyprotein", Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA. 87, 8898-8902 (1990)]. More recently, it was demonstrated that mutations at the active site of the HCV NS3 protease could completely abolish the HCV infection in a chimpanzee model [CM. Rice et al. "Hepatitis C virus-encoded enzymatic activities and conserved RNA elements in the 3'-nontranslated region are essential for virus replication in vivo." J. Virol.. 74(4) 2046-51 (2000)]. The HCV NS3 serine protease is also considered essential for viral replication as it and its associated cofactor, NS4A., help in the processing of all of the viral enzymes. This processing appears to be analogous to that carried out by the human immunodeficiency virus ("HIV") aspartyl protease. In addition, the demonstrated use of HTV protease inhibitors as potent antiviral agents in man demonstrates that interrupting a protease protein processing stage in the viral life cycle does result in therapeutically active agents. Consequently, the protease enzyme is an attractive target for drug discovery.

3
Several potential HCV protease inhibitors have been described. PCT Publications Numbers WO 00/09558, WO 00/09543, WO 99/64442, WO 99/07733, WO 99/07734, WO 99/50230, WO98/46630, WO 98/17679 and WO 97/43310, United States Patent No. 5,990,276, M. Llinas-Brunet et al., Bioore, Med. Chem, Lett., 8,1713-1718 (1998), W. Han et al., Bioorg. Med. Chem. Lett., 10, 711-713 (2000), R. Dunsdon et al., Bioorg. Med. Chem. Lett.. 20,1571-1579 (2000), M. Llinas-Brunet et al, Bioorg. Med. Chsm. Lett.. 10,2267-2270 (2000), and S. LaPlante et al., Bioorg. Med. Chem. Lett- K>, 2271-2274 (2000) each describe potential HCV NS3 protease inhibitors. Unfortunately, there are no serine protease inhibitors available currently as anti-HCV agents.
In fact, there are no anti-HCV therapies except interferon-a, interferon-a/ribavirin combination and more recently pegylated inteferon-a. The sustained response rates for the interferon-a therapies and interferon-oc/ribavirin however tend to be low ( In view of the current situation regarding anti-HCV therapeutics, it is clear that there is a need for more effective and better tolerated therapies.
Furthermore, synthesis of complex peptidomimetic compounds has long been hampered by the nonstereoselective nature of most synthetic organic processes. It is well known that the therapeutic activity of enantiomers of peptidomimetic compounds varies widely. It is therefore of great benefit to provide such stereospecific synthetic processes.
Previous attempts to synthesize chirally specific bicycloprolinate intermediates, useful in the synthesis of the present therapeutic peptidomimetic protease inhibitors have suffered from being non enatioselective, or diasteroselective, or long encompassing synthetic pathways, or being unsuitable for preparing large quantities of product. Thus, there is also a need for a means of

4
preparing large quantities of bicycloprolinates in a diastereoselective manner and enantiomerically enriched form.
Summary of the Invention
The present invention relates to a peptidomimetic compound of formula 1

wherein:
R is a bond or difluoromethylene;
R is hydrogen, optionally substituted aliphatic group, optionally substituted cyclic group or
optionally substituted aromatic group;
R2 and R9 are each independently optionally substituted aliphatic group, optionally substituted
cyclic group or optionally substituted aromatic group;
R3, R5 and R7 are each independently (optionally substituted aliphatic group, optionally
substituted cyclic group or optionally substituted aromatic group)(optionally substituted
methylene or optionally substituted ethylene), optionally substituted (1,1- or l,2-)cycloalkylene or
optionally substituted (1,1- or l,2-)heterocyclylene;
R4, R6, R8 and R10 are each independently hydrogen or optionally substituted aliphatic group;

is substituted monocyclic azaheterocyclyl or optionally substituted multicyclic azaheterocyclyl, or optionally substituted multicyclic azaheterocyclenyl wherein the unsaturatation is in the ring distal to the ring bearing the R9-L-(N(R8)-R7-C(O)-)nN(R6)-R5-C(O)-N moiety and to which the -C(O)-N(R4)-R3-C(O)C(O)NR2R1 moiety is attached; L is -C(O)-, -OC(O)-, -NR10C(O)-, -S(Oh-, or -NR10S(O)2-; and n is Oor 1, or
a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or prodrug thereof, or a solvate of such a compound, its salt or its prodrug, provided

5

aliphatic, or at least one of R , R and R7 is (optionally substituted aliphatic group, optionally substituted cyclic group or optionally substituted aromatic group)(optionally substituted ethanediyl), or R4 is optionally substituted aliphatic. This inventions also provides a compound having the structural formula:



wherein:
R1 is hydrogen, optionally substituted aliphatic group, optionally substituted cyclic group or
optionally substituted aromatic group;
R2 and R9 are each independently optionally substituted aliphatic group, optionally substituted
cyclic group or optionally substituted aromatic group;
R3, R5 and R7 are each independently (optionally substituted aliphatic group, optionally
substituted cyclic group or optionally substituted aromatic group)(optionally substituted
methanediyl or optionally substituted ethanediyl);
R4, R6, R8 and R10 are each independently is hydrogen or optionally substituted aliphatic group;

is substituted monocyclic azaheterocyclyl or optionally substituted multicyclic azaheterocyclyl, or optionally substituted multicyclic azaheterocyclenyl wherein the unsaturatation is in the ring distal to the ring bearing the R9-L-(N(R8)-R7-C(O)-)nN(R6)-R5-C(O)-N moiety and to which the -C(O)-N(R4)-R3-C(O)C(O)NR2R1 moiety is attached; L is -C(O)-, -OC(O)-, -NR10C(O)-, -S(O)2-, or -NR10S(O)r; and n is 0 or 1, or
a pharmaceutical ly acceptable salt or prodrug thereof, or a solvate of such a compound, its salt or its prodrug, provided

aliphatic, or at least one of R , R and R7 is (optionally substituted aliphatic group, optionally

6
substituted cyclic group or optionally substituted aromatic group)(optionally substituted ethanediyl), orR4is optionally substituted aliphatic.
The invention is also directed to a pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of formula 1, and method for using the compound of formula 1 for inhibiting HCV protease, or treating or preventing an HCV infection in patients or physiological condition related to the infection.
The invention is also directed to a stereoselective process for preparing a chiral bicycloproh'nate compound that is an intermediate useful in preparing a compound of formula 1. The synthetic process comprises the steps of:
(a) cleaving and cyclizmg a compound of formula 24



(24)
wherein:

is optionally substituted cycloalkyl or optionally substituted fused arylcycloalkyl;
Rnis-CO2R33;
R12 is an iminic glycinimide adduct;
R13 is acid protecting group or optionally substituted aliphatic group;
under cleaving and cyclizing conditions to form a compound of formula 25

wherein:

7

R14 is -CONR15R15, -CN;

or-CO2R16;
R15 is optionally substituted aliphatic group;
R16 is acid protecting group, optionally substituted aryl, or optionally substituted aliphatic group; and
(b) protecting the nitrogen of the lactam moiety in the compound of formula 25 with an amide protecting group to form a compound of formula 26

wherein:
p° is amide protecting group; R14 is as described herein; and
(c) reducing the compound of formula 26 under reducing conditions to form a compound of formula 27

wherein:
p° and R14 are as described herein; and
(d) deprotecting the compound of formula 27 under deprotecting conditions to form a compound of formula 28

8



wherein:
R14 is as described herein.
The invention is also directed to the above synthetic process further comprising the step wherein the compound of formula 24 is prepared by effecting a Michael addition with an iminic elycinimide compound on a compound of formula 29

is optionally substituted cycloalkenyl or optionally substituted fused
arylcycloalkenyl;
R11 is -CO2R13;
wherein:
the compound of formula 29 may be prepared by esterifying a compound of formula 29a

is optionally substituted cycloalkenyl or optionally substituted fused arylcycloalkenyl;
Rlla is -CHO, -COR15, -C^N ( or -CONR15R15; and
R15 is as described herein.
Notably, one skilled in the art would know that conversion of ketones to esters may be accomplished, for example, by a Bayer-Villiger reaction. Conversion of nitriles and amides to esters may be accomplished, for example, by aqueous hydrolysis followed by further

9
esterification. Conversion of aldehydes to esters may be accomplished, for example, by oxidation of the aldehyde followed by esterification.
Another aspect of the invention is a compound of formula 1 wherein the substituents are selected from a combination of preferred or particular embodiments as defined herein.
Another aspect of the invention is a compound of formulae 24-29 wherein the substituents are selected from a combination of preferred or particular embodiments as defined herein.
Another aspect of the invention are pharmaceutical compositions comprising, in addition to one or more HCV serine protease inhibitors, one or more interferons or compounds that induce the production of interferons that exhibit anti-HCV activity and/or one or more compounds having anti HCV activity, including immunomodulatory compounds such as immunostimulatory cytokines exhibiting HCV antiviral activity, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
Another aspect of the invention are methods of treating or preventing a HCV infection in a patient in need thereof, comprising administering to said patient a pharmaceutically effective amount of a combination of one or more HCV serine protease inhibitors; one or more interferons or compounds that induce the production of an inteferon that exhibit anti-HCV activity; and/or one or more compounds having anti-HCV activity, including immunomodulatory compounds such as immunostimulatory cytokines; exhibiting HCV antiviral activity.
The invention is also directed to the use of one or more HCV serine protease inhibitors in combination with one or more interferons or compounds that induce the production of an inteferon that exhibit anti-HCV activity and/or one or more compounds having anti-HCV activity, including immunomodulatory compounds such as immunostimulatory cytokines exhibiting HCV antiviral activity, to prepare a medicament for treating or preventing a HCV infection in a patient in need thereof.
The present invention is also directed to a kit or pharmaceutical pack for treating or preventing HCV infection in a patient, wherein the kit or pharmaceutical pack comprises a plurality of separate containers, wherein at least one of said containers contains one or more HCV serine protease inhibitors (alone or in combination with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent), at least another of said containers contains one or more interferons or compounds that induce the production of an inteferon that exhibit anti-HCV activity, (alone or in combination with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent) and, optionally, at least another of said containers contains one or more compounds having anti-HCV activity (alone or in combination with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent), including immunomodulatory compounds such as immunostimulatory cytokines exhibiting HCV antiviral activity.
The amount of the HCV serine protease inhibitor(s), interferon(s), or anti-HCV compound(s) in any of the foregoing applications can be a pharmaceutically effective amount, a

10
subclinical anti-HCV effective amount, or combinations thereof, so long as the final combination of HCV serine protease inhibitors), interferon(s), or compounds that induce the production of an interferon that exhibit anti-HCV activity, and/or anti-HCV compound(s) comprises a phannaceuticany effective amount of compounds that is effective in treating or preventing HCV infection in a patient.
Brief Description of the Drawings
The above and other aspects, features, and advantages of the present invention will be better understood from the following detailed description taken in conjunction with the accompanying drawings, all of which are given by way of illustration only, and are not limitative of the present invention, in which:
Figure 1 shows the inhibition of HCV replicon RNA accumulation after 48 hour treatment of replicon-containing cells with Compound CXJ and interferon-alpha 2B, individually or in combination.
Figure 2 graphically shows the isobol concavity exhibited by compounds used in combination that are antagonistic, additive, and synergistic according to the synergy calculation methods of Greco, Park and Rustom ((1990) Application of a New Approach for the Quantitation of Drug Synergism to the Combination of cis-Diamminedichloroplatinum and 1-6-D-Arabinofuranosylcytosine, Cancer Research, 50,5318-5327).
Figure 3 shows the geometric relationship between a and the amount of curvature in the isobol. A hypothetical isobol at the E = 50% effect level is displayed with a straight line isobol that would be expected under additivity. M is the point of intersection of the line y = x and the hypothetical isobol. N is the point of intersection of the line y = x and the straight line isobol. O is the origin (0,0). S gives a measure of the amount of curvature in the isobol, where S = ON/OM. ON is the distance from O to N and OM is the distance from O to M. The parameter a is related to S by the equation a = 4(S2 - S).
Figure 4 shows the isobol calculations using the method of Greco et al., supra, for the combination of compound CU and interferon alpha-2B (Schering-Plough) using 6 dilutions of each compound in Experiment 1
Figure 5 shows the isobol calculations using the method of Greco et al., supra, for the combination of compound CU and interferon alpha-2A using 6 dilutions of each compound in Experiment 2.

11
Figure 6 shows the isobol calculations using the method of Greco et al., supra, for the combination of compound CU and interferon alpha-2B (Schering-Plough) using 8 dilutions of each compound in Experiment 3.
Figure 7 shows the isobol calculations using the method of Greco et al., supra, for the combination of compound CU and interferon alpha-2A using 8 dilutions of each compound in Experiment 4.
Figure 8 shows the isobol calculations using the method of Greco et al., supra, for the combination of compound CU and ovine interferon tau using 8 dilutions of each compound in Experiment 5.
Figure 9 shows the isobol calculations using the method of Greco et al., supra, for the combination of compound EC and interferon alpha-2B (Schering-Plough) using 8 dilutions of each compound in Experiment 6.
Figure 10 shows the isobol calculations using the method of Greco et al., supra, for the combination of compound EC and interferon alpha-2A vising 8 dilutions of each compound in Experiment 7.
Figure 11 shows the isobol calculations using the method of Greco et al., supra, for the combination of compound CU and interferon beta using 8 dilutions of each compound in Experiment 8.
Figure 12 shows the isobol calculations using the method of Greco et al., supra, for the combination of compound EP and interferon alpha-2B (Schering-Plough) using 8 dilutions of each compound in Experiment 9.
Figure 13 shows the isobol calculations using the method of Greco et al., supra, for the combination of Ribavirin and interferon alpha-2B (Schering-Plough) using 8 dilutions of each compound in Experiment 10.
Figure 14 shows inhibition of HCV replicon RNA accumulation caused by treatment of replicon cells with either (A) Ribavirin alone or (B) interferon alpha-2B alone. In both panels, the measured inhibition as well as the inhibition corrected for cytotoxicity of the compounds is shown.
Detailed Description of the Invention
The contents of each of the patent documents and other references cited herein are herein incorporated by reference in their entirety.
As used above, and throughout the description of the invention, the following abbreviations, unless otherwise indicated, shall be understood to have the following meanings:-

12
Designation Reagent or Fragment
ACN acetonitrile
AIBN 2,2'-azobisisobutyronitrile
BOC or Boc tert-butyl carbamate
BOP benzotriazol-l-y]-oxytris(dimethylamino)phosphomum
hexafluorophosphate
n-Bu3SnH tri-n-butyltin hydride
t-Bu tert-butyl
Cbz benzyl carbamate
chiral PTC chiral phase transfer catalyst



DAST (diethylamino)sulfur trifluoride (Et2NSF3)
DCC dicyclocarbodiimide
DCM dichloromethane (CH2C12)
DIBAL-H Diisobutylaluminum hydride
DIC 1,3-diisopropylcarbodiimide
DIPEA diisopropylethylamine
DMAP 4-(N,N-dimethylamino)pyridine
DMP reagent Dess-Martin Periodinane reagent

DMF dimethylforraamide
DMSO dimethylsulfoxide
EA elemental analysis
EDCI l-ethyl-3-(3-diraethyIaminopropyl)
carbodiimide HC1

13
eq equivalents)
Et ethyl
Et2O diethyl ether
EtOH ethanol
EtOAc ethyl acetate
Et3Si triethylsilane
FMOC 9-fluorenylmethoxycarbonyl

H-Chg-OH
HOAt 1 -hydroxy-7-azabensotriazole
HOBT 1-hydroxybenztriazole
HOSu N-hydroxysuccinamide
HPLC high performance liquid chromatography
LAH lithium aluminum anhydride
Me methyl
Mel methyliodide
MeOH methanol
MeOC(O)Cl methyl chloroformate
MOMC1 methoxymethylchloride
MOM methoxymethyl
MS mass spectroscopy
NaBH4 sodium borohydride
Na2C4H4O6 sodium tartrate
NMP N-methyl pyrrolidinone
NMR nuclear magnetic resonance
P- Polymer bond
PyBOP benzotriazole-l-yl-oxytris-pyrrolidino-phosphonium
hexafluorophosphate
TBD l,5,7-triazabicyclo[4.4.0]-dec-5-ene
RP-HPLC reverse phase - high pressure liquid chromatography
TBSCI tert-butyldimethylsilyl chloride
TCA trichloroacetic acid

14

TFA trifluoroacetic acid Tf2O triflate anhydride THF tetrahydrofuran THP tetrahydropyran TLC thin layer chromatography
As used above, and throughout the description of the invention, the following terms, unless otherwise indicated, shall be understood to have the following meanings:-
"Acid bioisostere" means a group which has chemical and physical similarities producing broadly similar biological properties to a carboxy group (see Lipinski, Annual Reports in Medicinal Chemistry, "Bioisosterism In Drug Design" 21., 283 (1986); Yun, Hwahak Sekye, "Application Of Bioisosterism To New Drug Design" 33, 576-579, (1993); Zhao, Huaxue Tongbao, "Bioisosteric Replacement And Development Of Lead Compounds In Drug Design" 34-38, (1995); Graham, Theochem, "Theoretical Studies Applied To Drug Design:ab initio Electronic Distributions In Bioisosteres" 343,105-109, (1995)). Exemplary acid bioisosteres include -C(O)-NHOH, -C(O)-CH2OHt -C(O)-CH2SH, -C(O)-NH-CN, sulpho, phosphono,
alkylsulphonylcarbamoyl, tetrazolyl, arylsulphonylcarbamoyl, N-methoxycarbamoyl, heteroarylsulphonylcarbamoyl, 3-hydroxy-3-cyclobutene-l,2-dione, 3,5-dioxo-l,2,4-oxadiazolidinyl or hydroxyheteroaryl such as 3-hydroxyisoxazolyl, 3-hydoxy-l-methylpyrazolyl and the like.
"Acidic functional group" means a moiety bearing an acidic hydrogen. Exemplary acid functional groups include carboxyl (-C(O)OH), -C(O)-NHOH, -C(O)-CH2OH, -C(O)-CH2SH,
-C(O)-NH-CN, sulpho, phosphono, alkylsulphonylcarbamoyl, tetrazolyl, arylsulphonylcarbamoyl, N-methoxycarbamoyI, heteroarylsulphonylcarbamoyl, 3-hydroxy-3-cyclobutene-l,2-dione, 3,5-dioxo-l,2,4-oxadiazolidinyl or hydroxyheteroaryl such as 3-hydroxyisoxazolyl, 3-hydoxy-l-methylpyrazolyl, imidazolyl, mercapto, and the like, and an appropriate hydroxy such as an aromatic hydroxy, e.g., hydroxyphenyl.
"Acid protecting group" means an easily removable group that is known in the art to protect an acidic hydrogen of a carboxyl group against undesirable reaction during synthetic procedures, e.g., to block or protect the acid functionality while the reactions involving other functional sites of the compound are carried out, and to be selectively removable. Such acid protecting groups are well known to those skilled in the art, having been extensively used in the protection of carboxyl groups, as described in U.S. Pat. No. 3,840,556 and 3,719,667, the disclosures of which are hereby incorporated herein by reference. For suitable acid protecting groups, see T.W. Green and P.G.M.Wuts in "Protective Groups in Organic Chemistry" John

15
Wiley and Sons, 1991. Acid protecting group also includes hydrogenation labile acid protecting group as defined herein. Exemplary acid protecting groups include esters such as substituted and unsubstituted C]-8 lower alkyl, e.g., methyl, ethyl, /-butyl, methoxymethyl, methylthiomethyl, 2,2,2-trichloroethyl and the like, tetrahydropyranyl, substituted and unsubstituted phenylalkyl such as benzyl and substituted derivatives thereof such as alkoxybenzyl or nitrobenzyl groups and the like, cinnamyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, e.g., dimethylaminoethyl and the like, trimethylsilyl, substituted and unsubstituted amides and hydrazides, e.g., amides and hydrazides of N,N-dimethylamine, 7-nitroindole, hydrazine, N-phenylhydrazine and the like, acyloxyalkyl groups such as pivaloyloxymethyl or propionyloxymethyl and the like, aroyloxyalkyl such as benzoyloxyethyl and the like, alkoxycarbonylalkyl such as methoxycarbonyimethyl, cyclohexyloxycarbonylmethyl and the like, alkoxycarbonyloxyalkyl such as t-butyloxycarbonyloxymethyl and the like, alkoxycarbonylaminoalkyl such as t-butyloxycarbonylaminomethyl and the like, alkylaminocarbonylaminoalkyl, such as methylaminocarbonylaminomethyl and the like, acylaminoalkyl such as acetylaminomethyl and the like, heterocyclylcarbonyloxyalkyl such as 4-methylpiperazinyI-carbonyloxymethyl and the like, dialkylaminocarbonylalkyl such as dimethylaminocarbonyl-methyl and the like, (5-(lower alkyl)-2-oxo-l,3-dioxolen-4-yl)alkyl such as (5-f-butyl-2-oxo-l,3-dioxolen-4-yl)methyl and the like, and (5-phenyl-2-oxo-l,3-dioxolen-4-yl)alkyl such as (5-phenyl-2-oxo-l,3-dioxolen-4-yl)methyl and the like.
"Acid labile amine protecting group" means an amine protecting group as defined herein which is readily removed by treatment with acid while remaining relatively stable to other reagents. A preferred acid labile amine protecting group is BOC.
"Aliphatic" means alkyl, alkenyl or alkynyl as defined herein.
"Aliphatic group substituent(s)" mean substituents attached to an aliphatic group as defined herein inclusive of aryl, heteroaryl, hydroxy, alkoxy, cyclyloxy, aryloxy, heteroaryloxy, acyl or its thioxo analogue, cyclylcarbonyl or its thioxo analogue, aroyl or its thioxo analogue, heteroaroyl or its thioxo analogue, acyloxy, cyclylcarbonyloxy, aroyloxy, heteroaroyloxy, halo, nitro, cyano, carboxy (acid), -C(O)-NHOH, -C(O)-CH2OH, -C(O)-CH2SH, -C(O)-NH-CN,
sulpho, phosphono, alkylsulphonylcarbamoyl, tetrazolyl, arylsulphonylcarbamoyl, N-methoxycarbamoyl, heteroarylsulphonylcarbamoyl, 3-hydroxy-3-cyclobutene-l,2-dione, 3,5-dioxo-l,2,4-oxadiazolidinyl or hydroxyheteroaryl such as 3-hydroxyisoxazolyl, 3-hydoxy-l-methylpyrazolyl, alkoxycarbonyl, cyclyloxycarbonyl, aryloxycarbonyl, heteroaryloxycarbonyl, alkylsulfonyl, cyclylsulfonyl, arylsulfonyl, heteroaryl sulfonyl, alkylsulfinyl, cyclylsulfinyl, arylsulfmyl, heteroarylsulfinyl, alkylthio, cyclylthio, arylthio,

16
heteroarylthio, cyclyl, aryldiazo, heteroaryldiazo, thiol, methylene (H2C=), oxo (O=), thioxo (S=), Y1Y2N-, Y1Y2NC(O)-, Y1Y2NC(O)0-, Y1Y2NC(O)NY3-, Y1Y2NSO2- or Y3SO2NY1- wherein R2 is as defined herein, Y1 and Y2 are independently hydrogen, alkyl, aryl or heteroaryl, and Y3 is alkyl, cycloalkyl aryl or heteroaryl, or for where the substituent is Y1 Y2N-, then one of Y1 and Y2 may be acyl, cyclylcarbonyl, aroyl, heteroaroyl, alkoxycarbonyl, cyclyloxycarbonyl, aryloxycarbonyl or heteroaryloxycarbonyl, as defined herein and the other of Y1 and Y2 is as defined previously, or for where the substituent isY'Y2NC(O)-, Y'Y^aOO-, Y1Y2NC(O)NY3-or Y1Y2NSO2-, Y1 and Y2 may also be taken together with the N atom through which Yl and Y2
are linked to form a 4 to 7 membered azaheterocyclyl or azaheterocyclenyl. Acidic/amide aliphatic group substituents are carboxy (acid), -C(O)-NHOH, -C(O)-CH2OH, -C(0)-CH2SH,
-C(O)-NH-CN, sulpho, phosphono, alkylsulphonylcarbamoyl, tetrazolyl, arylsulphonylcarbamoyl, N-methoxycarbamoyl, heteroarylsulphonylcarbamoyl, 3-hydroxy-3-cyclobutene-l,2H3ione, 3,5-dioxo-l,2,4-oxadiazolidinyl or hydroxyheteroaryl such as 3-hydroxyisoxazolyl, 3-hydoxy-l-methylpyrazoIyl and Y1Y2NCO-. Non-acidic polar aliphatic group substituents are hydroxy, oxo (O=), thioxo (S=), acyl or its thioxo analogue, cyclylcarbonyl or its thioxo analogue, aroyl or its thioxo analogue, heteroaroyl or its thioxo analogue, alkoxycarbonyl, cyclyloxycarbonyl, aryloxycarbonyl, heteroaryloxycarbonyl, acyloxy, cyclylcarbonyloxy, aroyloxy, heteroaroyloxy, alkylsulfonyl, cyclylsulfonyl, arylsulfonyl, heteroarylsulfonyl, alkylsulfinyl, cyclylsulfinyl, arylsulfinyl, heteroarylsulfinyl, thiol, Y1Y2-, Y1Y2C(O)-, Y!Y2NC(O)O-, Y1Y2NC(O)NY3- or YlY2NSO2-. Exemplary aliphatic groups bearing an aliphatic group substituent include methoxymethoxy, methoxyethoxy, ethoxyethoxy, (methoxy-, benzyloxy-, phenoxy-, or ethoxy-)carbony](methyl or ethyl), benzyloxycarbonyl, pyridylmethyloxy-carbonylmethyl, methoxyethyl, ethoxymethyl, n-butoxymethyl, cyclopentylmethyloxy ethyl, phenoxypropyl, phenoxyallyl, trifluoromethyl, cyclopropyl-methyl, cyclopentylraethyl, carboxy(methyl or ethyl), 2-phenethenyl, benzyloxy, 1- or 2-naphthyl-methoxy, 4-pyridyl-methyIoxy, benzyloxyethyl, 3-benzyloxyallyl, 4-pyridylmethyl-oxyethyl, 4-pyridylmethyl-oxyallyl, benzyl, 2-phenethyl, naphthylmethyl, styryl, 4-phenyl-l ,3-pentadienyl, phenyl-propynyl, 3-phenylbut-2-ynyl, pyrid-3-yIacetylenyl and quinolin-3-ylacetylenyl, 4-pyridyl-ethynyl, 4-pyridylvinyl, thienylethenyl, pyridylethenyl, imidazolyl-ethenyl, pyrazinylethenyl, pyridylpentenyl, pyridylhexenyl and pyridylheptenyl, thienyl-methyl, pyridylmethyl, iinidazolylmethyl, pyrazinylraethyl, tetrahydropyranylmethyl, tetrahydropyranyl-methyloxymethyl, and the like.
"Acyl" means an H-CO- or (aliphatic or cyclyl)-CO- group wherein the aliphatic group is as herein described. Preferred acyls contain a lower alkyl. Exemplary acyl groups include

17
formyl, acetyl, propanoyl, 2-methylpropanoyl, butanoyl, palmitoyl, acryloyl, propynoyl, cyclohexylcarbonyl, and the like.
"Alkenoyl" means an alkenyl-CO- group wherein alkenyl is as defined herein.
"Alkenyl" means an aliphatic hydrocarbon group containing a carbon-carbon double bond and which may be straight or branched having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms in the chain. Preferred alkenyl groups have 2 to about 12 carbon atoms in the chain; and more preferably about 2 to about 4 carbon atoms in the chain. Branched means that one or more lower alkyl groups such as methyl, ethyl or propyl are attached to a linear alkenyl chain. "Lower alkenyl" means about 2 to about 4 carbon atoms in the chain that may be straight or branched. Exemplary alkenyl groups include ethenyl, propenyl, n-butenyl, /-butenyl, 3-methylbut-2-enyl, n-pentenyl, heptenyl, octenyl, cyclohexylbutenyl, decenyl, and the like.. "Substituted alkenyl" means an alkenyl group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "aliphatic group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein. Exemplary alkenyl alphatic group substituents include halo or cycloalkyl groups
"Alkenyloxy" means an alkenyl-O- group wherein the alkenyl group is as herein described. Exemplary alkenyloxy groups include allyloxy, 3-butenyloxy, and the like.
"Alkoxy" means an alkyl-O- group wherein the alkyl group is as herein described. Exemplary alkoxy groups include methoxy, ethoxy, n-propoxy, i-propoxy, n-butoxy, heptoxy, and the like.
"Alkoxycarbonyl" means an alkyl-O-CO- group, wherein the alkyl group is as herein defined. Exemplary alkoxycarbonyl groups include methoxycarbonyl, ethoxycarbonyl, /-butyloxycarbonyl, and the like.
"Alkyl" means an aliphatic hydrocarbon group which may be straight or branched having about 1 to about 20 carbon atoms in the chain. Preferred alkyl groups have 1 to about 12 carbon atoms in the chain, more preferred is lower alkyl as defined herein. Branched means that one or more lower alkyl groups such as methyl, ethyl or propyl are attached to a linear alkyl chain. "Lower alkyl" means about 1 to about 4 carbon atoms in the chain that may be straight or branched. "Substituted alkyl" means an alkyl group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "aliphatic group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different, and are as defined herein.
"Alkylsulfmyl" means an alkyl-SO- group wherein the alkyl group is as defined above. Preferred groups are those wherein the alkyl group is lower alkyl.
"Alkylsulfonyl" means an alkyl-SCVgroup wherein the alkyl group is as defined above. Preferred groups are those wherein the alkyl group is lower alkyl.

18
"Alkylsulphonylcarbamoyl" means an alkyl-S02"NH-C(=O)- group wherein the alkyl group is as herein described. Preferred alkylsulphonylcarbamoyl groups are those wherein the alky] group is lower alky 1.
"AlkylthJo" means an alkyl-S- group wherein the alkyl group is as herein described. Exemplary alkylthio groups include methylthio, ethylthio, r-propylthio and heptylthio.
"Alkynyl" means an aliphatic hydrocarbon group containing a carbon-carbon triple bond and which may be straight or branched having about 2 to about 15 carbon atoms in the chain. Preferred alkynyl groups have 2 to about 12 carbon atoms in the chain; and more preferably about 2 to about 4 carbon atoms in the chain. Branched means that one or more lower alkyl groups such as methyl, ethyl or propyl are attached to a linear alkynyl chain. "Lower alkynyl" means about 2 to about 4 carbon atoms in the chain that may be straight or branched. The alkynyl group may be substituted by one or more halo. Exemplary alkynyl groups include ethynyl, propynyl, n-butynyl, 2-butynyl, 3-methylbutynyl, ;z-pentynyl, heptynyl, octynyl, decynyl, and the like. "Substituted alkynyl" means alkynyl as defined above which is substituted with one or more "aliphatic group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different, and are as defined herein.
"Amine protecting group" means an easily removable group that is known in the art to protect a nitrogen moietyof an amino or amide group against undesirable reaction during synthetic procedures and to be selectively removable. The use of amine/amide protecting groups is well known in the art for protecting groups against undesirable reactions during a synthetic procedure and many such protecting groups are known, for example, T.W. Greene and P.G.M. Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis, 2nd edition, John Wiley & Sons, New York (1991), incorporated herein by reference. Amine/amide protecting group also includes "acid labile amine/amide protecting group" and "hydrogenation labile amine/amide protecting group". Exemplary amine/amide protecting groups are acyl, including formyl, acetyl, chloroacetyl, trichloroacetyl, o-nitrophenylacetyl, o-nitrophenoxy-acetyl, trifluoroacetyl, acetoacetyl, 4-chlorobutyryl, isobutyryl, o-nitrocinnamoyl, picolinoyl, acylisothiocyanate, aminocaproyl, benzoyl and the like, and acyloxy including methoxy-carbonyl, 9-fluorenylmethoxycarbonyl, 2,2,2-trifluoroethoxycarbonyl, 2-trimethylsilylethoxy-carbonyl, vinyloxycarbonyl, allyloxycarbonyl, r-butyloxycarbonyl (BOC), 1,1-dimethyl-propynyloxycarbonyl, benzyloxycarbonyl (CBZ), p-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl, 2,4-dichloro-benzyloxycarbonyl, and the like.
"Amide protecting group" means an easily removable group that is known in the art to protect a nitrogen moiety of an amide group against undesirable reaction during synthetic procedures and to be selectively removable after its conversion to the amine. The use of amide protecting groups is well known in the art for protecting groups against undesirable reactions

19
during a synthetic procedure and many such protecting groups are known, for example, T.W. Greene and P.G.M. Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis, 2nd edition, John Wiley & Sons, New York (1991), incorporated herein by reference. Amide protecting group also includes "acid labile amide protecting group" and "hydrogenation labile amide protecting group". 5 Exemplary amide protecting groups are o-nitrocinnamoyl, picolinoyl, aminocaproyl, benzoyl and the like, and acyloxy including methoxy-carbonyl, 9-fluorenylmethoxycarbonyl, 2,2,2-trifluoroethoxycarbonyl, 2-trimethylsilylethoxy-carbonyl, vinyloxycarbonyl, allyloxycarbonyl, t-butyloxycarbony] (BOC), 1,1-dimethyI-propynyloxycarbonyl, benzyloxycarbonyl (CBZ), p-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl, 2,4-dichloro-benzyloxycarbonyl, and the like.
10 "Amino acid" means an amino acid selected from the group consisting of natural and
unnatural amino acids as defined herein. Amino acid is also meant to include -amino acids having L or D stereochemistry at the o:-carbon. Preferred amino acids are those possessing an a-amino group. The amino acids may be neutral, positive or negative depending on the substituents in the side chain. "Neutral amino acid" means an amino acid containing uncharged
15 side chain substituents. Exemplary neutral amino acids include alanine, valine, leucine, isoleucine, proline, phenylalanine, tryptophan, methionine, glycine, serine, threonine and cysteine. "Positive amino acid" means an amino acid in which the side chain substituents are positively charged at physiological pH. Exemplary positive amino acids include lysine, arginine and histidine, **Negative amino acid" means an amino acid in which the side chain substituents
20 bear a net negative charge at physiological pH. Exemplary negative amino acids include aspartic acid and glutamic acid. Preferred amino acids are a-amino acids. Exemplary natural amino acids are isoleucine, proline, phenylalanine, tryptophan, methionine, glycine, serine, threonine, cysteine, tyrosine, asparagine, glutamine, lysine, arginine, histidine, aspartic acid and glutamic acid. Unnatural amino acid" means an amino acid for which there is no nucleic acid codon.
25 Exemplary unnatural amino acids include, for example, the D-isomers of the natural a-amino acids as indicated above; Aib (aminobutyric acid), fSAib (3-amino-isobutyric acid), Nva (norvaline), [3-Ala, Aad (2-aminoadipic acid), pAad (3-aminoadipic acid), Abu (2-aminobutyric acid), Gaba (y-aminobutyric acid), Acp (6-aminocaproic acid), Dbu (2,4-diaminobutryic acid), a-aminopimelic acid, TMSA (trimethylsilyl-Ala), alle (allo-isoleucine), Nle (norleucine), /erf-Leu,
30 Cit (citrulline), Om, Dpm (2,2'-diammopimelic acid), Dpr (2,3-diaminopropionic acid), a- or (3-Nal, Cha (cyclohexyl-Ala), hydroxyproline, Sar (sarcosine), and the like; cyclic amino acids; Na-alkylated amino acids such as MeGly
(N^-methylglycine), EtGly (Na-ethylglycine) and EtAsn (Na-ethylasparagine); and amino acids in which the a-carbon bears two side-chain substituents. The names of natural and unnatural amino

20
acids and residues thereof used herein follow the naming conventions suggested by the IUPAC Commission on the Nomenclature of Organic Chemistry and the IUPAC-IUB Commission on Biochemical Nomenclature as set out in "Nomenclature of a-Amino Acids (Recommendations, 1974)" Biochemistry, 14(2), (1975). To the extent that the names and abbreviations of ainino acids and residues thereof employed in this specification and appended claims differ from those noted, differing names and abbreviations will be made clear.
"Amino acid protecting group" mean a group that protects an acid or amine moiety of the amino acid or other reactive moiety on the side chain of an amino acid, e.g., hydroxy or thiol. For examples of "corresponding protected derivatives" of amino acid side chains, see T.W. Green and P.G.M. Wuts in "Protective Groups in Organic Chemistry" John Wiley and Sons, 1991. Protecting groups for an acid group in an amino acid are described herein, for example in the sections "acidic functional group" and "hydrogenation labile acid protecting group". Protecting groups for an amine group in an amino acid are described herein, for example in the sections "amine protecting group", "acid labile amine protecting group" and "hydrogenation labile amine protecting group".
"Amino acid residue" means the individual amino acid units incorporated into the compound of the invention.
"Amino acid side chain" means the substituent found on the carbon between the amino and carboxy groups in a-amino acids. Exemplary o -amino acid side chains include isopropyl, methyl, and carboxymethyl for valine, alanine, and aspartic acid, respectively.
"Amino acid equivalent" means an amino acid that may be substituted for another amino acid in the peptides according to the invention without any appreciable loss of function. In making such changes, substitutions of like amino acids are made on the basis of relative similarity of side chain substituents, for example regarding size, charge, hydrophilicity, hydropathicity and hydrophobicity as described herein.
"Aromatic group" means aryl or heteroaryl as defined herein. Exemplary aromatic groups include phenyl, halo substituted phenyl, azaheteroaryl, and the like.
"Aroyl" means an aryl-CO- group wherein the aryl group is as herein described. Exemplary aroyl groups include benzoyl, 1- and 2-naphthoyl, and the like.
"Aryl" means an aromatic monocyclic or multicyclic ring system of about 6 to about 14 carbon atoms, preferably of about 6 to about 10 carbon atoms. Encompassed by aryl are fused arylcycloalkenyl, fused arylcycloalkyl, fused arylheterocyclenyl and fused arylheterocyclyl as defined herein when bonded through the aryl moiety thereof. The aryl is optionally substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" which may be the same or different and are as defined herein. Exemplary aryl groups include phenyl or naphthyl, or phenyl substituted or naphthyl

21
substituted. "Substituted aryl" means an aryl group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein.
"Aryldiazo" means an aryl-diazo- group wherein the aryl and diazo groups are as defined herein.
"Arylene" means an optionally substituted 1,2-, 1,3-, 1,4-, bivalent aryl group, wherein the aryl group is as defined herein. Exemplary arylene groups include optionally substituted phenylene, naphthylene and indanylene. A particular arylene is optionally substituted phenylene. "Substituted arylene" means an arylene group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein.
"Aryloxy" means an aryl-O- group wherein the aryl group is as defined herein. Exemplary aryloxy groups include phenoxy and 2-naphthyloxy.
"Aryloxycarbonyl" means an aryl-O-CO- group wherein the aryl group is as defined herein. Exemplary aryloxycarbonyl groups include phenoxycarbonyl and naphthoxycarbonyl.
"Arylsulfonyl" means an aryl-SCV group wherein the aryl group is as defined herein.
"Arylsulphonylcarbamoyl" means an aryl-SC>2-NH-C(=O)- group wherein the aryl group
is as herein described. An exemplary arylsulphonylcarbamoyl group is phenylsulphonylcarbamoyl.
"Arylsulfmyl" means an aryl-SO- group wherein the aryl group is as defined herein.
"Arylthio" means an aryl-S- group wherein the aryl group is as herein described. Exemplary arylthio groups include phenylthio and naphthylthio.
"Basic nitrogen atom" means a sp2 or sp3 hybridized nitrogen atom having a non-bonded pair of electrons which is capable of being protonated. Exemplary basic nitrogen atoms include optionally substituted imino, optionally substituted amino and optionally substituted amidino groups.
"Carboxy" means an HO(O)C- (carboxylic acid) group.
"Coupling agent" means a compound that reacts with the hydroxyl moiety of a carboxy moiety thereby rendering it susceptible to nucleophilic attack. Exemplary coupling agents include DIC, EDCI, DCC, and the like.
"Cydoalkenyl" means a non-aromatic mono- or multicyclic ring system of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, preferably of about 5 to about 10 carbon atoms, and which contains at least one carbon-carbon double bond. Encompassed by cycloalkenyl are fused arylcycloalkenyl and fused heteroarylcycloalkenyl as defined herein when bonded through the cycloalkenyl moiety thereof. Preferred ring sizes of rings of the ring system include about 5 to about 6 ring atoms; and

22
such preferred ring sizes are also referred to as "lower". "Substituted cycloalkenyl" means an cycloalkyenyl group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein. Exemplary monocyclic cycloalkenyl include cyclopentenyl, cyclohexenyl, cycloheptenyl, and the like. An exemplary multicyclic cycloalkenyl is norbornylenyl.
"Cycloalkyl" means a non-aromatic mono- or multicyclic ring system of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, preferably of about 5 to about 10 carbon atoms. Preferred ring sizes of rings of the ring system include about 5 to about 6 ring atoms; and such preferred ring sizes are also referred to as "lower". Encompassed by cycloalkyl are fused arylcycloalkyl and fused heteroarylcycloalkyl as defined herein when bonded through the cycloalkyl moiety thereof. "Substituted cycloalkyl" means a cycloalkyl group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein. Exemplary monocyclic cycloalkyl include cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cycloheptyl, and the like. Exemplary multicyclic cycloalkyl include 1-decalin, norbornyl, adamant-(l- or 2-)yl, and the like.
"Cycloalkylene" means a bivalent cycloalkyl group as defined herein having about 4 to about 8 carbon atoms. Preferred ring sizes of the cycloalkylene include about 5 to about 6 ring atoms; and such preferred ring sizes are also referred to as "lower". The points of binding on the cycloalkylene group include 1,1-, 1,2-, 1,3-, or 1,4-binding patterns, and where applicable the stereochemical relationship of the points of binding is either cis or trans. Exemplary cycloalkylene groups include (1,1-, 1,2- or l,3-)cyclohexylene and (1,1- or l,2-)cyclopentylene. "Substituted cycloalkylene" means an cycloalkylene group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein
"Cyclic" or "Cyclyl" means cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocyclyl or heterocyclenyl as defined herein. The term "lower" as used in connection with the term cyclic is the same as noted herein regarding the cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocyclyl or heterocyclenyl.
"Cyclyloxy" means a cyclyl-O- group wherein the cyclyl group is as herein described. Exemplary cycloalkoxy groups include cyclopentyloxy, cyclohexyloxy, quinuclidyloxy, pentamethylenesulfideoxy, tetrahydropyranyloxy, tetrahydrothiophenyloxy, pyrrolidinyloxy, tetrahydrofuranyloxy or 7-oxabicycIo[2.2.1]heptanyloxy, hydroxytetrahydropyranyloxy, hydroxy-7-oxabicyclo[2.2.1]heptanyloxy, and the like.
"Cyclylsulfinyl" means a cyclyl-S(O)- group wherein the cyclyl group is as herein described.

23
"Cyclylsulfonyl" means a cycIyl-S(O)2- group wherein the cyclyl group is as herein described.
"Cyclylthio" means a cyclyl-S- group wherein the cyclyl group is as herein described.
"Diazo" means a bivalent -N=N- radical.
"Displaceable moiety" means a group that where associated with L as defined herein is subject to being displaced by nucleophilic attack by a mono- or di-substituted amine moiety with or without the presence of an agent that facilitates said attack, e.g., coupling agent. Exemplary displaceable moieties include hydroxy, aliphatic oxy, halo, N-oxysuccinimide, acyloxy, and the like.
"Effective amount" is means an amount of a compound/composition according to the present invention effective in producing the desired therapeutic effect.
"Fused arylcycloalkenyl" means a fused aryl and cycloalkenyl as defined herein. Preferred fused arylcycloalkenyls are those wherein the aryl thereof is phenyl and the cycloalkenyl consists of about 5 to about 6 ring atoms. A fused arylcycloalkenyl as a variable may be bonded through any atom of the ring system thereof capable of such. "Substituted fused arylcycloalkenyl" means a fused arylcycloalkenyl group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein. Exemplary fused arylcycloalkenyl include 1,2-dihydronaphthylene, indene, and the like.
"Fused arylcycloalkyr means a fused aryl and cycloalkyl as defined herein. Preferred fused arylcycloalkyls are those wherein the aryl thereof is phenyl and the cycloalkyl consists of about 5 to about 6 ring atoms. A fused arylcycloalkyl as a variable may be bonded through any atom of the ring system thereof capable of such. "Substituted fused arylcycloalkyl" means a fused arylcycloalkyl group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein. Exemplary fused arylcycloalkyl includes 1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-naphthylene, and the like.
"Fused arylheterocyclenyl" means a fused aryl and heterocyclenyl as defined herein. Preferred fused arylheterocyclenyls are those wherein the aryl thereof is phenyl and the heterocyclenyl consists of about 5 to about 6 ring atoms. A fused arylheterocyclenyl as a variable may be bonded through any atom of the ring system thereof capable of such. The designation of the aza, oxa or thia as a prefix before heterocyclenyl portion of the fused arylheterocyclenyl define that at least a nitrogen, oxygen or sulfur atom is present, respectively, as a ring atom. "Substituted fused arylheterocyclenyl" means a fused arylheterocyclenyl group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "rimg group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein. The nitrogen atom of a fused arylheterocyclenyl

24
may be a basic nitrogen atom. The nitrogen or sulfur atom of the heterocyclenyl portion of the fused arylheterocyclenyl may also be optionally oxidized to the corresponding N-oxide, S-oxide or S,S-dioxide. Exemplary fused arylheterocyclenyl include 3H-indolinyl, lH-2-oxoquinolyl, 2H-l-oxoisoquinolyl, 1,2-di-hydroquinolinyl, 3,4-dihydroquinolinyl, 1,2-dihydroisoquinolinyl, 3,4-dihydroisoquinolinyl, and the like.
"Fused arylheterocyclyl" means a fused aryl and heterocyclyl as defined herein. Preferred fused arylheterocyclyls are those wherein the aryl thereof is phenyl and the heterocyclyl consists of about 5 to about 6 ring atoms. A fused arylheterocyclyl as a variable may be bonded through any atom of the ring system thereof capable of such. The designation of the aza, oxa or thia as a prefix before heterocyclyl portion of the fused arylheterocyclyl define that at least a nitrogen, oxygen or sulfur atom is present, respectively, as a ring atom. "Substituted fused arylheterocyclyl" means a fused arylheterocyclyl group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein. The nitrogen atom of a fused arylheterocyclyl may be a basic nitrogen atom. The nitrogen or sulfur atom of the heterocyclyl portion of the fused arylheterocyclyl may also be optionally oxidized to the corresponding N-oxide, S-oxide or S,S-dioxide. Exemplary fused arylheterocyclyl ring systems include indolinyl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinoline, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinoline, lH-2,3-dihydroisoindol-2-yl, 2,3-dihydrobenz[f]isoindol-2-yl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydrobenz[g]-isoquinolin-2-yl, and the like.
"Fused heteroarylcycloalkenyl" means a fused heteroaryl and cycloalkenyl as defined herein. Preferred fused heteroarylcycloalkenyls are those wherein the heteroaryl thereof is phenyl and the cycloalkenyl consists of about 5 to about 6 ring atoms. A fused heteroaryl-cycloalkenyl as a variable may be bonded through any atom of the ring system thereof capable of such. The designation of the aza, oxa or thia as a prefix before heteroaryl portion of the fused heteroarylcycloalkenyl define that at least a nitrogen, oxygen or sulfur atom is present, respectively, as a ring atom. "Substituted fused heteroarylcycloalkenyl" means a fused heteroarylcycloalkyenyl group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 30 which may be the same or different and are as defined herein. The nitrogen atom of a fused heteroarylcycloalkenyl may be a basic nitrogen atom. The nitrogen atom of. the heteroaryl portion of the fused heteroarylcycloalkenyl may also be optionally oxidized to the corresponding N-oxide. Exemplary fused heteroarylcyclo-alkenyl include 5,6-dihydroquinolyl, 5,6-dihydroisoquinolyl, 5,6-dihydroquinoxalinyl, 5,6-dihydroquinazolinyl, 4,5-dihydro-lH-benzimidazolyl, 4,5-di-hydrobenzoxazolyl, and the like.
"Fused heteroarylcycloalkyl" means a fused heteroaryl and cycloalkyl as defined herein. Preferred fused heteroarylcycloalkyls are those wherein the heteroaryl thereof consists of about 5

25
to about 6 ring atoms and the cycloalkyl consists of about 5 to about-6 ring atoms. A fused heteioarykycloalkyl as a variable may be bonded through any atom of the ring system thereof capable of such. The designation of the aza, oxa or thia as a prefix before heteroaiyl portion of the fused heteroarylcycloalkyl define that at least a nitrogen, oxygen or sulfur atom is present, respectively, as a ring atom. "Substituted fused heteroarylcycloalkyl" means a fused heteroarylcycloalkyl group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein. The nitrogen atom of a fused heteroarylcycloalkyl may be a basic nitrogen atom. The nitrogen atom of the heteroaryl portion of the fused heteroarylcycloalkyl may also be optionally oxidized to the corresponding N-oxide. Exemplary fused heteroarylcycloalkyl include 5,6,7,8-tetrahydroquinolinyl, 5,6,7,8-tetra-hydroisoquinolyl, 5,6,7,8-tetrahydroquinoxalinyl, 5,6,7,8-tetrahydroquinazolyl-,
4,5,6,7-tetrahydro-IH-benzimidazolyl, 4,5,6,7-tetrahydrobenzoxazolyI, lH-4-oxa-l,5-diazanaphthalen-2-onyI, l,3-dihydroimidizole-[4,5]-pyridin-2-onyl, and the like.
"Fused heteroarylheterocyclenyl1" means a fused heteroaryl and heterocyclenyl as defined herein. Preferred fused heteroarylheterocyclenyls are those wherein the heteroaryl thereof consists of about 5 to about 6 ring atoms and the heterocyclenyl consists of about 5 to about 6 ring atoms. A fused heteroarylheterocyclenyl as a variable may be bonded through any atom of the ring system thereof capable of such. The designation of the aza, oxa or thia as a prefix before the heteroaryl or heterocyclenyl portion of the fused heteroarylhetero-cyclenyl define that at least a nitrogen, oxygen or sulfur atom is present, respectively, as a ring atom. "Substituted fused heteroarylheterocyclenyl" means a fused heteroarylheterocyclenyl group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein. The nitrogen atom of a fused heteroarylazaheterocyclenyl may be a basic nitrogen atom. The nitrogen or sulfur atom of the heteroaryl portion of the fused heteroarylheterocyclyl may also be optionally oxidized to the corresponding N-oxide. The nitrogen or sulfur atom of the heteroaryl or heterocyclyl portion of the fused heteroarylheterocyclyl may also be optionally oxidized to the corresponding N-oxide, S-oxide or S,S-dioxide. Exemplary fused heteroarylheterocyclenyl include 7,8-dihydro[l,7]naphthyridinyl, l,2-dihydro[2,7]-naphthyridinyl, 6,7-dihydro-3H-imidazo[4,5-c]pyridyl, l,2-dihydro-l,5-naphthyridrayl,
1,2-dihydro-l ,6-naphthyridinyl, 1,2-dihydro-l ,7-naphthyridinyl, 1,2-dihydro-l ,8-naphthyridinyl, l,2-dihydro-2,6-naphthyridinyl, and the like.
"Fused heteroarylheterocyclyl" means a fused heteroaryl and heterocyclyl as defined herein. Preferred fused heteroarylheterocyclyls are those wherein the heteroaryl thereof consists

26
of about 5 to about 6 ring atoms and the heterocyclyl consists of about 5 to about 6 ring atoms. A fused heteroarylheterocyclyl as a variable may be bonded through any atom of the ring system thereof capable of such. The designation of the aza, oxa or thia as a prefix before the heteroaryl or heterocyclyl portion of the fused heteroarylheterocyclyl define that at least a nitrogen, oxygen or sulfur atom is present, respectively, as a ring atom. "Substituted fused heteroarylheterocyclyl" means a fused heteroarylheterocyclyi group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein The nitrogen atom of a fused heteroarylheterocyclyl may be a basic nitrogen atom. The nitrogen or sulfur atom of the heteroaryl portion of the fused heteroarylheterocyclyl may also be optionally oxidized to the corresponding N-oxide. The nitrogen or sulfur atom of the heteroaryl or heterocyclyl portion of the fused heteroarylheterocyclyl may also be optionally oxidized to the corresponding N-oxide, S-oxide or S,S-dioxide. Exemplary fused heteroarylheterocyclyl include 2,3-dihydro-lH pyrrol[3,4-b]quinolin-2-yl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydrobenz [b][l,71naphthyridin-2-yl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydrobenz [b]tl,6]naphthyridin-2-yl, 1,2,3,4-tetra-hydro-9H-pyrido[3,4-b]indol-2yl, l,2,3,4-tetrahydro-9H-pyrido[4,3-b]indoI-2yl, 2,3-dihydro-lH-pyrrolo[3,4-b]indol-2-yl, lH-2,3,4,5-tetrahydroazepino[3,4-b]indol-2-yl, lH-2,3,4,5-tetra-hydroazepino[4,3-b]indol-3-yl, lH-2,3,4,5-tetrahydroazepino[4,5-b]indol-2 yl, 5,6,7,8-tetra-hydro[l,7jnapthyridyl, l,2,3,4-tetrhydio[2,7]naphthyridyl, 2,3-dihydro[l,4]dioxino[2,3-b]pyridyl, 2,3-dihydro-[l,4]dioxino[2,3-b]pyridyi,3,4-dihydro-2H-l-oxa[4,6Jdiazanaphthalenyl, 4,5,6,7-tetrahydro-3H-imidazo[4,5-c]pyridyI,6,7-dihydro[5,8]diazanaphthalenyl, l,2,3,4-tetrahydro[l,5}-napthyridinyl, l,2,3,4-tetrahydro[l,6]napthyridinyl, l,2,3,4-tetrahydro[l,7]napthyridinyl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydro[l,8]napthyridinyl, l,2,3,4-tetra-hydro[2,6]napthyridinyl, and the like.
"Halo" means fluoro, chloro, bromo, or iodo. Preferred are fluoro, chloro or bromo, and more preferred are fluoro or chloro.
"Heteroaroyl" means an heteroaryl-CO- group wherein the heteroaryl group is as herein described. Exemplary heteroaroyl groups include thiophenoyl, nicotinoyl, pyrrol-2-yIcarbonyl, 1-and 2-naphthoyl, pyridinoyl, and the like. "
"Heteroaryl" means an aromatic monocyclic or multicyclic ring system of about 5 to about 14 carbon atoms, preferably about 5 to about 10 carbon atoms, in which one or more of the carbon atoms in the ring system is/are hetero element(s) other than carbon, for example nitrogen, oxygen or sulfur. Preferably the ring system includes 1 to 3 heteroatoms. Preferred ring sizes of rings of the ring system include about 5 to about 6 ring atoms. .Encompassed by heteroaryl are fused heteroarylcycloalkenyl, fused heteroarylcycloalkyl, fused heteroarylheterocyclenyl and fused heteroarylheterocyclyl as defined herein when bonded through the heteroaryl moiety thereof. "Substituted heteroaryl" means a heteroaryl group as defined above which is substituted

27
with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein. The designation of the aza, oxa or thia as a prefix before heteroaryl define that at least a nitrogen, oxygen or sulfur atom is present, respectively, as a ring atom. A nitrogen atom of an heteroaryl may be a basic nitrogen atom and may also be optionally oxidized to the corresponding N-oxide. Exemplary heteroaryl and substituted heteroaryl groups include pyrazinyl, thienyl, isothiazolyl, oxazolyl, pyrazolyl, furazanyl, pyrrolyl, 1,2,4-thiadiazolyl, pyridazinyl, quinoxalinyl, phthalazinyl, imidazo[l,2-a]pyridine, imidazo[2,l-b]thiazolyl, benzofurazanyl, azaindolyl, benzimidazolyl, benzothienyl, thienopyridyl, thienopyrimidyl, pyrrolopyridyl, imidazopyridyl, benzoazaindolyl, 1,2,4-triazinyl, benzthiazolyl, furanyl, imidazolyl, indolyl, indolizinyl, isoxazolyl, isoquinolinyl, isothiazolyl, oxadiazolyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazolyl, pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrrolyl, quinazolinyl, quinolinyl, 1,3,4-thiadiazolyl, thiazolyl, thienyl, triazolyl, and the like. A preferred heteroaryl group is pyrazinyl.
"Heteroaryldiazo" means an heteroaryl -azo- group.wherein the heteroaryl and azo groups are as defined herein.
"Heteroarylidyr means a bivalent radical derived from a heteroaryl, wherein the heteroaryl is as described herein. An exemplary heteroaryldiyl radical is optionally substituted pyridinediyl.
"Heteroarylsulphonylcarbamoyl" means a heteroaryl-SO2-NH-C(=O)- group wherein the
heteroaryl group is as herein described.
"Heterocyclenyl" means a non-aromatic monocyclic or multicyclic hydrocarbon ring system of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, preferably about 5 to about 10 carbon atoms, in which one or more of the carbon atoms in the ring system is/are hetero element(s) other than carbon, for example nitrogen, oxygen or sulfur atoms, and which contains at least one carbon-carbon double bond or carbon-nitrogen double bond. Preferably, the ring includes 1 to 3 heteroatoms. Preferred ring sizes of rings of the ring system include about 5 to about 6 ring atoms; and such preferred ring sizes are also referred to as "lower". Encompassed by heterocyclenyl are fused arylheterocyclenyl and fused heteroarylheterocyclenyl as defined herein when bonded through the heterocyclenyl moiety thereof. The designation of the aza, oxa or thia as a prefix before heterocyclenyl define that at least a nitrogen, oxygen or sulfur atom is present, respectively, as a ring atom. "Substituted heterocyclenyl" means a heterocyclenyl group as defmed above which is substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein . The nitrogen atom of an heterocyclenyl may be a basic nitrogen atom. The nitrogen or sulfur atom of the heterocyclenyl may also be optionally oxidized to the corresponding N-oxide, S-oxide or S,S-dioxide. Exemplary monocyclic azaheterocyclenyl groups include 1,2,3,4-tetrahydrohydropyridine,

28
1,2-dihydropyridyl, 1,4-dihydropyridyl, 1,2,3,6-tetra-hydropyridine, 1,4,5,6-tetrahydro-pyrimidme, 2-pyiTolinyl, 3-pyrrolinyl, 2-imidazolinyI, 2-pyrazolinyl, and the like. Exemplary oxaheterocyclenyl groups include 3,4-dihydro-2tf-pyran, dihydrofuranyl, and fluorodihydro-furanyl. AD exemplary multicyclic oxaheterocyclenyl group is 7-oxabicyclo[2.2.1]heptenyl. Exemplary monocyclic thiaheterocyclenyl rings include dihydrothiophenyl and di hydrothiopyranyl.
"Heterocyclyl" means a non-aromatic saturated monocyclic or multicyclic ring system of about 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, preferably about 5 to about 10 carbon atoms, in which one or more of the carbon atoms in the ring system is/are hetero element(s) other than carbon, for example nitrogen, oxygen or sulfur. Preferably, the ring system contains from 1 to 3 heteroatoms. Preferred ring sizes of rings of the ring system include about 5 to about 6 ring atoms; and such preferred ring sizes are also referred to as "lower". Encompassed by heterocyclyl are fused arylheterocyclyl and fused heteroarylheterocyclyl as defined herein when bonded through the heterocyclyl moiety thereof. The designation of the aza, oxa or thia as a prefix before heterocyclyl define that at least a nitrogen, oxygen or sulfur atom is present respectively as a ring atom. "Substituted heterocyclyl" means a heterocyclyl group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein The nitrogen atom of an heterocyclyl may be a basic nitrogen atom. The nitrogen or sulfur atom of the heterocyclyl may also be optionally oxidized to the corresponding N-oxide, S-oxide or S,S-dioxide. Exemplary monocyclic heterocyclyl rings include piperidyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperazinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, thiazolidinyl, 1,3-dioxolanyl, 1,4-dioxanyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, tetrahydrothiophenyl, tetrahydrothiopyranyl, and

the like. -^ as substituted monocyclic azaheterocyclyl is substituted directly or through a linker by at least one substituent that is, or encompasses, or is substituted by an aromatic group as
25 defined herein; for example aryl, heteroaryl, aryloxy, heteroaryloxy, aroyl or its thioxo analogue, heteroaroyl or its thioxo analogue, aroyloxy, heteroaroyloxy, aryloxycarbonyl, heteroaryloxycarbonyl, arylsulfonyl, heteroarylsulfonyl, arylsulfinyl, heteroarylsulfinyl, arylthio, heteroarylthio, aryldiazo, heteroaryldiazo, Y]Y2N-, YVNCXO)-, YVNC^O-, Y1Y2NC(O)NY3- or Y'Y^SC^- wherein at least one of Y1 and Y2 is, encompasses or is
30 substituted by an aryl or heteroaryl moiety. Preferred linkers include -C(O)-, -OC(O)-, lower alkyl, lower alkoxy, lower alkenyl, -O-, -Ss -C(O)C(O)-, -S(O)-, -S(O)2-, -NR80-, where R80 is hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocyclyl or heteroaryl. Particularly preferred linkers are -C(O)- and -OC(O)-. " Substituted multicyclic azaheterocyclyl" means a multicyclic

29
azaheterocyclyl group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein. " Substituted multicyclic azaheterocyclenyl" means a multicyclic azaheterocyclenyl group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein.
"Heterocyclylene" means a bivalent heterocyclyl group as defined herein having about 4 to about 8 carbon atoms. Preferred ring sizes of the heterocyclylene include about 5 to about 6 ring atoms; and such preferred ring sizes are also referred to as "lower". The points of binding on the cycloalkylene group include 1,1-, 1,2-, 1,3-, or 1,4- binding patterns, and where applicable the stereochemical relationship of the points of binding is either cis or trans. Exemplary heterocyclylene groups include (1,1-, 1,2- or l,3-)piperidinylene and (1,1- or l,2-)tetrahydrofuranylene. " Substituted heterocyclylene" means a heterocyclylene group as defined above which is substituted with one or more "ring group substituents" (preferably 1 to 3) which may be the same or different and are as defined herein.
"Hydrate" means a solvate wherein the solvent molecule(s) is/are H2O.
"Hydrogenation labile amine protecting group" means an amine protecting group as defined herein which is readily removed by hydrogenation while remaining relatively stable to other reagents. A preferred hydrogenation labile amine protecting group is Cbz.
"Hydrogenation labile acid protecting group" means an acid protecting group as defined herein which is readily removed by hydrogenation while remaining relatively stable to other reagents. A preferred hydrogenation labile acid protecting group is benzyl.
"Hygroscopicity" means sorption, implying an acquired amount or state of water sufficient to affect the physical or chemical properties of the substance (Eds. J. Swarbrick and J.C. Boylan, Encyclopedia of Pharmaceutical Technology, K), 33).
"Iminic glycinimide derivative" means an iminic Schiff base of a glycine that is useful in the synthesis of of a-amino acids, both natural and unnatural. The iminic ester functionality may contain one or more assymetric centers that may aid in stereoinduction during the bond formating process. In addition, these iminic glycinimide derivatives may be incorporated onto polymeric supports to facilitate combinatorial synthesis. Iminic glycinimide derivatives may be prepared by condensing a glycine ester with the appropropriate ketone in the presence of an acid catalyst. The reaction is facilitated by the removal of water. Iminic glycinimide derivatives are well known in the art for use in Michael Addition synthetic procedures, for example as disclosed by Guillena, G., et al., J. Org. Chem. 2000,65,7310-7322, herein incorporated by reference. Particular examples of iminic glycinimide derivatives according to the invention include one selected from

30

the group of formulae



wherein:
M* is a transition metal, preferably CU, more preferably CUn.



R. is optionally substituted aliphatic group;
R16 is acid protecting group, optionally substituted aryl, or optionally substituted aliphatic group;
R17 is optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted aliphatic group,



R18 is hydrogen, alkyl, or alkylthio; or optionally substituted aryl;
R17 and R18 taken together with the carbon to which R17 and R18 are attached

is a solid phase.
"Iminic glycinimide derivative adduct" means the resulting compound where an
31
derivative adducts according to the invention include one selected from the group of formulae



wherein:
R14, R17, and R18 are defined as described in the definition of iminic glycinimide derivative herein.

"N-oxysuccinimide" means a moiety of the following structure
"N-oxide" means a moiety of the following structure
"Patient" includes both human and other mammals.
"Peptidomimetic" mean a polymer encompassing amino acid residues joined together through amide bonds.
"Pharmaceutically acceptable ester" refers to esters that hydrolyze in vivo and include those that break down readily in the human body to leave the parent compound or a salt thereof. Suitable ester groups include, for example, those derived from pharmaceutically acceptable aliphatic carboxylic acids, particularly alkanoic, alkenoic, cycloalkanoic and alkanedioic acids, in which each alkyl or alkenyl moiety advantageously has not more than 6 carbon atoms. Exemplary esters include formates, acetates, propionates, butyrates, acrylates, ethylsuccinates, and the like.
"Pharmaceutically acceptable prodrugs" as used herein refers to those prodrugs of the compounds of the present invention wltich are, within the scope of sound medical judgement, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of humans and lower animals with undue toxicity, irritation, allergic response, and the like, commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio, and effective for their intended use, as well as the zwitterionic forms, where possible, of the compounds of the invention. The term "prodrug" refers to compounds that are rapidly transformed in vivo to yield the parent compound of the above formula, for example by hydrolysis in blood. Functional groups that may be rapidly transformed, by metabolic cleavage, in vivo form a class of groups reactive with the carboxyl group of the compounds of this invention. They

32
include, but are not limited to such groups as alkanoyl (such as acetyl, propanoyl, butanoyl, and the like), unsubstituted and substituted aroyl (such as benzoyl and substituted benzoyl), alkoxycarbonyl (such as ethoxycarbonyl), trialkylsilyl (such as trimethyl- and triethysilyl), monoesters formed with dicarboxylic acids (such as succinyl), and the like. Because of the ease with which the metabolically cleavable groups of the compounds of this invention are cleaved in vivo, the compounds bearing such groups act as pro-drugs. The compounds bearing the metabolically cleavable groups have the. advantage that they may exhibit improved bioavailability as a result of enhanced solubility and/or rate of absorption conferred upon the parent compound by virtue of the presence of the metabolically cleavable group. A thorough discussion is provided in Design of Prodrugs, H. Bundgaard, ed., Elsevier (1985); Methods in Enzymology; K. Widder et al, Ed., Academic Press, 42, 309-396 (1985); A Textbook of Drug Design and Developement, Krogsgaard-Larsen and H. Bandaged, ed., Chapter 5; "Design and Applications of Prodrugs" 113-191 (1991); Advanced Drug Delivery Reviews, H. Bundgard, 8,1-38, (1992); J. Pharm. Sci., 77,285 (1988); Chem. Pharm. Bull., N. Nakeya et al, 32, 692 (1984); Pro-drugs as Novel Delivery Systems, T. Higuchi and V. Stella, 14 A.C.S. Symposium Series, and Bioreversible Carriers in Drug Design, E.B. Roche, ed., American Pharmaceutical Association and Pergamon Press, 1987, which are incorporated herein by reference.
"Pharmaceutically acceptable salts" refers to the relatively non-toxic, inorganic and organic acid addition salts, and base addition salts, of compounds of the present invention. These salts can be prepared in situ during the final isolation and purification of the compounds. In particular, acid addition salts can be prepared by separately reacting the purified compound in its free base form with a suitable organic or inorganic acid and isolating the salt thus formed. Exemplary acid addition salts include the hydrobromide, hydrochloride, sulfate, bisulfate, phosphate, nitrate, acetate, oxalate, valerate, oleate, palmitate, stearate, laurate, borate, benzoate, lactate, phosphate, tosylate, citrate, maleate, furnarate, succinate, tartrate, naphthylate, mesylate, glucoheptonate, lactiobionate, sulphamates, malonates, salicylates, propionates, methylene-bis-P-hydroxynaphthoates, ge:ntisates, isethionates, di-p-toluoyltartrates, methanesulphonates, ethanesulphonates, benzenesulphonates, p-toluenesulphonates, cyclohexylsulphamates and quinateslaurylsulphonate salts, and the like. See, for example S.M. Berge, et al., "Pharmaceutical Salts," J. Pharm. Sci., 66, 1-19 (1977) which is incorporated herein by reference. Base addition salts can also be prepared by separately reacting the purified compound in its acid form with a suitable: organic or inorganic base and isolating the salt thus formed. Base addition salts include pharmaceutically acceptable metal and amine salts. Suitable metal salts include the sodium, potassium, calcium, barium, zinc, magnesium, and aluminum salts. The sodium and potassium salts are preferred. Suitable inorganic base addition salts are

33
prepared from metal bases which include sodium hydride, sodium hydroxide, potassium hydroxide, calcium hydroxide, aluminum hydroxide, lithium hydroxide, magnesium hydroxide, zinc hydroxide and the like. Suitable amine base addition salts are prepared from amines which have sufficient basicity to form a stable salt, and preferably include those amines which are frequently used in medicinal chemistry because of their low toxicity and acceptability for medical use. ammonia, ethylenediamine, N-methyl-glucamine, Iysine, arginine, ornithine, choline, N.N1-dibenzylethylenedi amine, chJoroprocaine, diethanolamine, procaine, N-benzylphenethylamine, diethylamine, piperazine, tris(hydroxymethyl)-aminomethane, tetramethylammonium hydroxide, triethylamine, dibenzylamine, ephenamine, dehydroabietylamine, N-ethylpiperidine, benzylamine, tetramethylammonium, tetraethylammonium, methylamine, dimethylamine, trimethylamine, ethylamine, basic amino acids, e.g., Iysine and arginine, and dicyclohexylamine, and the like.
"Ring group substituents" mean substituents attached to aromatic or non-aromatic ring systems inclusive of aryl, heteroaryl, hydroxy, alkoxy, cyclyloxy, aryloxy, heteroaryloxy, acyl or its thioxo analogue, cyclylcarbonyl or its thioxo analogue, aroyl or its thioxo analogue, heteroaroyl or its thioxo analogue, acyloxy, cyclylcarbonyloxy, aroyloxy, heteroaroyloxy, halo, nitro, cyano, carboxy (acid), -C(O)-NHOH, -C(O)-CH2OH, -C(O)-CH2SH, -C(O)-NH-CN,
sulpho, phosphono, alkylsulphonylcarbamoyl, tetrazolyl, arylsulphonylcarbamoyl, N-methoxycarbamoyl, heteroarylsulphonylcarbamoyl, 3-hydroxy-3-cyclobutene-l,2-dione, 3,5-dioxo-l,2,4-oxadiazolidinyl or hydroxyheteroaryl such as 3-hydroxyisoxazolyl, 3-hydoxy-l-methylpyrazoly, alkoxycarbonyl, cyclyloxycarbonyl, aryloxycarbonyl, heteroaryloxycarbonyl, alkylsulfonyl, cyclylsulfonyl, arylsulfonyl, heteroarylsulfonyl, alkylsulfinyl, cyclylsulfinyl, arylsulfinyl, heteroarylsulfinyl, alkylthio, cyclylthio, arylthio, heteroarylthio, cyclyl, aryldiazo, heteroaryldiazo, thiol, Y'Y2N-, Y]Y2NC(O)-, Y'Y^CCCOO-, YVNCXC^NY3- or Y]Y2NSO2-, wherein Y1, Y2 and Y3 are independently hydrogen, alkyl, aryl
or heteroaryl, or for where the substituent is Y'Y2N-, then one of Y1 and Y2 may be acyl, cyclylcarbonyl, aroyl, heteroaroyl, alkoxycarbonyl, cyclyloxycarbonyl, aryloxycarbonyl or heteroaryloxycarbonyl, as defined herein and the other of Y1 and Y2 is as defined previously, or for where the substituent isY^NCXO)-, YlY2liC(O)O-, YIY2NC(O)NY3- or Y1Y2NSO2-, Y1 and Y2 may also be taken together with the N atom through which Y1 and Y2 are linked to form a 4 to 7 membered azaheterocyclyl or azaheterocyclenyl. When a ring system is saturated or partially saturated, the "ring group substituents" further include, methylene (H2C=0, oxo (O=) and thioxo (S=). Acidic/amide ring group substituents are carboxy (acid), -C(O)-NHOH, -C(O)-CH2OH, -
C(O)-CH2SH, -C(O)-NH-CN, sulpho, phosphono, alkylsulphonylcarbamoyl, tetrazolyl,

34
arylsulphonylcarbamoyl, N~methoxycarbamoyl, heteroarylsulpbonylcarbamoyl, 3-hydroxy-3-cyclobutene-l,2-dione, 3,5-dioxo-l,2,4-oxadiazoIidinyl or hydroxyheteroaryl such as 3-hydroxyisoxazolyl, 3-hydoxy-l-methyIpyrazoly and Y^NCO-. Non-acidic polar ring group substituents are hydroxy, oxo (O=), thioxo (S=), acyl or its thioxo analogue, cyclylcarbonyl or its thioxo analogue, aroyl or its thioxo analogue, heteroaroyl or its thioxo analogue, alkoxycarbonyl, cyclyloxycarbonyl, aryloxycarbonyl, heteroaryloxycarbonyl, acyloxy, cyclylcarbonyloxy, aroyloxy, heteroaroyloxy, alkylsulfonyl, cyclylsulfonyl, arylsulfonyl, heteroarylsulfonyl, alkylsulfinyl, cyclylsulfinyl, arylsulfinyl, heteroarylsutfinyl, thiol, Y]Y2N-, Y^NCXO)-, YVNaCOO-, Y]Y2NC(O)NY3- or Y1Y2NSO2--
"Solvate" means a physical association of a compound of this invention with one or more solvent molecules. This physical association includes hydrogen bonding. In certain instances the solvate will be capable of isolation, for example when one or more solvent molecules are incorporated in the crystal lattice of the crystalline solid. "Solvate" encompasses both solution-phase and isolable solvates. Exemplary solvates include hydrates, ethanolates, methanolates, and the like.
Embodiments
With reference to inventions described herein, below are particular and preferred embodiments are related thereto.
A particular embodiment according to the invention is where R is a bond.
Another particular embodiment according to the invention is where R is difl uoromethylene.
A particular embodiment according to the invention is where R is hydrogen or optionally substituted lower aliphatic group.
Another particular embodiment according to the invention is where R is hydrogen or lower alkyl.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R is hydrogen.
A particular embodiment according to the invention is where R2 is optionally substituted lower aliphatic group or optionally substituted monocyclic group.
Another particular embodiment according to the invention is where R is optionally substituted lower alkyl, optionally substituted lower alkenyl, or optionally substituted monocyclic cycloalkyl.
Further particular embodiment according to the invention is where R is carboxymethyl, l-carboxy-2-phenylethyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, 1-cyclohexylethyl, 1-phenylethyl, but-2-yl, 1-pyrid
-4-ylethyl, propen-3-yl or 3-metbylbut-2-yl; more preferred cyclopropyl.

35
A particular embodiment according to the invention is where R3 is optionally substituted lower aliphatic group methylene.
Another particular embodiment according to the invention is where R3 is optionally halo substituted lower (alkyl or alkenyl)methylene.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R3 is propylmethylene, 2,2-difluoroethylmethylene, 2,2,2-trifluoromethylene or propen-3-ylmethylene; more preferred R3 is propylmethylene or 2,2-difluoroethylmethylene; further preferred R3 is propylmethylene.
A particular embodiment according to the invention is where R4 is hydrogen or optionally substituted lower aliphatic group.
Another particular embodiment according to the invention is where R4 is hydrogen or lower alkyl.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R4 is hydrogen.
A particular embodiment according to the invention is where R5 is optionally substituted lower aliphatic group methylene.
Another particular embodiment according to the invention is where R5 is optionally (phenyl, carboxy, carboxamido or alkoxycarbonyl) substituted lower (alkyl or alkenyl) methylene.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R3 is methylmethylene, isopropylmethylene, r-butylmethylene, but-2-ylmethylene, butylmethylene, benzylmethylene, 3-methylbutylmethylene, 2-rnethylpropyl-rnethylene, carboxymethylmethylene, carboxamidomethylmethylene, benzyloxycarbonylmethylmethylene, benzyloxycarbonylpropylmethylene, or phenylpropen-3-ylmethylene; more preferred R5 is isopropylmethylene or r-butyl-methylene.
A particular embodiment according to the invention is where R6 is hydrogen or optionally substituted lower aliphatic group.
Another particular embodiment according to the invention is where R6 is hydrogen or lower alkyl.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R is hydrogen.
A particular embodiment according to the invention is where R7 is optionally substituted lower aliphatic group methylene, optionally substituted lower cyclic group methylene or optionally substituted monocyclic (aryl or heteroaryl) methylene.
Another particular embodiment according to the invention is where R7 is optionally substituted lower alkylmethylene, optionally substituted lower cycloalkylmethylene or optional substituted phenylmethylene.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R7 is methylmethylene, isopropylmethylene, n-propylmethylene, phenylmethylene, cyclohexylmethylene,

36
cyclopentylmethylene, t-butylmethylene, s-butyl methylene, cyclohexylmethylmethylene, or phenylmethylraethylene; more preferred is isopropylmethylene, cyclohexylmethylene, cyclopentylmethylene, t-butylmethylene or s-butylmethylene.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is also wherein each of R3, R5, and R7 is mono substituted methylene.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is also wherein R3 is mono substituted methylene and has an (S) configuration on the carbon attached to the -C(O)-R°-C(O)-NR1R2 moiety.
A particular embodiment according to the invention is where R8 is hydrogen or optionally substituted lower aliphatic group.
Another particular embodiment according to the invention is where R8 is hydrogen or lower alkyl.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R8 is hydrogen.
A particular embodiment according to the invention is where R9 is optionally substituted lower aliphatic group or optionally substituted monocyclic aromatic group.
Another particular embodiment according to the invention is where R9 is optionally substituted lower alkyl or optionally substituted monocyclic heteroaryl.
Another particular embodiment according to the invention is where R9 is optionally (carboxy, (loweralkyl)SO2NH-, (lower alkyl)HNCO-, hydroxy, phenyl, heteroaryl, or (lower alkyl )OC(O)NH-)-substituted lower alkyl, or optionally substituted monocyclic heteroaryl.
A further preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R9 is lower alkyl substituted by (mono- or di-)MeOC(O)NH-; more preferred is l,2-di(MeOC(O)NH)ethyl or 1-(MeOC(O)NH)ethyl.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R9 is (carboxy, (lower alkyl)HNCO- or tetrazolyl)substituted lower alkyl; more preferred 3-carboxypropyl, 2-tetrazol-5ylpropyl, 3-(N-methylcarboxamido)propyl or 3-carboxy-2,2-dimethylpropyl; further preferred is 3-carboxypropyl, 2-tetrazol-5ylpropyl or 3-(N-methylcarboxamido)propyl.
Another preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R9 is optionally substituted lower alkyl; more preferred is l-hydroxy-2-phenylethyl, methyl, isopropyl or /-butyl; further preferred is methyl, isopropyl or f-butyl.

37 Another preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R9 is selected from the



Yet another preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R9 is pyrazinyl.
A particular embodiment according to the invention is where R10 is hydrogen or optionally substituted lower aliphatic group.
Another particular embodiment according to the invention is where R10 is hydrogen or lower alkyl.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R10 is hydrogen.


A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where monocyclic azaheterocyclyl is substituted pyrrolidinyl.

as a substituted

38


A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where

is a substituted




monocyclic azaheterocyclyl is optionally substituted

or optionally substituted


,wherein Ar is R that comprises an aromatic moiety; more preferred is optionally



substituted

further preferred is optionally substituted

Ar N^
6 6
Further preferred optionally substituted
1N is l or
^ ; yet further preferred N or

39

Another preferred embodiment according to the invention is where

as an



optionally substituted rnulticyclic azaheterocyclyl is optionally substituted

;more





preferred is optionally substituted tluoro or oxo.

, Particular substituents for

are hydroxy,



Another preferred embodiment according to the invention is where

as an



optionally substituted rnulticyclic azaheterocyclenyl is optionally substituted

a
N

;more





preferred is

further preferred is




Another preferred embodiment according to the invention is where

as an


optionally substituted rnulticyclic azaheterocyclenyl is optionally substituted
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where the -C(O)-N(R4)-R3-


C(O)R°C(O)NR2R1 moiety attached to
s attached a carbon a to the nitrogen atom.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where L is -C(O)- or -OC(O)-. A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where n is 0. Another preferred embodiment according to the invention is where n is 1. A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R11 is -CO2R13.

40

A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R12 is
A particular embodiment according to the invention is where R13 is an optionally substituted aliphatic group.
Another particular embodiment according to the invention is where R13 is an alkyl group.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R13 is lower alkyl.
Another preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R13 is methyl.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where RId is -CO2R16.
A particular embodiment according to the invention is where R15 is alkyl.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R13 is lower alkyl.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R13 is methyl.
A particular embodiment according to the invention is where R16 is optionally substituted aliphatic.
Another particular embodiment according to the invention is where R16 is alkyl.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R16 is lower alkyl.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R16 is t-Bu.
A particular embodiment according to the invention is where R17 is optionally substituted aryl.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R17 is phenyl.
A particular embodiment according to the invention is where R18 is optionally substituted aryl.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where R18 is phenyl.
A particular embodiment according to the invention is where p is selected from the group consisting of BOC, CBz, and -CO2alkyl.
A preferred embodiment according to the invention is where p° is BOC.
It is to be understood that this invention covers all appropriate combinations of the particular and preferred groupings referred to herein.
Particular compounds according to the invention are selected from the group of compounds A-FH consecutively consisting of

41


42


43


44


45





47


48


49


50


51


52


53


54


55


56


57


58


59


60


61


62


63


64


65


66





68


69

or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or prodrug thereof, or a solvate of such a compound, its salt or its prodrug.
A preferred compound is one selected from the group consisting of S, U, BW, BX, BY, BZ, CE, CU, CW, CY, DZ, EA, EC, EJ, FH, EW, EO, EZ, FG and EN a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or prodrug thereof, or solvate of such compound, its salt or its prodrug.
Another preferred embodiment of the invention are selected from the following group of compounds:


70


71


72


73


74


75


76


77


78


79



5 or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or prodrug thereof, or a solvate of such a compound, its salt or its prodrug.
Another preferred embodiment of the invention is a compound of the formula

or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or prodrug thereof, or a solvate of such a compound, its salt or its prodrug.
Another preferred embodiment of the invention is compound of formula 1 wherein: R° is a bond; R1 is hydrogen;
R2 is lower alkyl optionally substituted with 1 to 3 aliphatic group substituents ;or lower cycloalky optionally substituted with 1 to 3 cyclic group substituents; R3 and R5 are each independently methylene optionally substituted with 1 to 3 aliphatic group substitutents;
R4, R6, R8 and R10 are hydrogen;
R7 is methylene substituted with cycloalkyl, lower alkyl or aryl;or or (1,1- or l,2-)cycloalkenyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, lower alkyl or aryl; R9is
lower alkyl optionally substituted with 1 to 3 aliphatic group substituents; or
heteroaryl optionally substituted with 1 to 3 cyclic group substituents;
or heterocyclic optionally substituted with 1 to 3 cyclic group substituents;

80

is monocyclic azaheterocydyl, raulticyclic azaheterocyclyl, or multicyclic azaheterocyclenyl optionally substituted with from 1 to 3 cyclic group substituents; and L is -QO)-, -OC(O)-.
Another preferred embodiment of the invention is a compound selected from the group consisting of:



81


82


83


84


85


86


87


88


89


90


91


92


93


94


95


96


97


98



99
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or prodrug thereof, or a solvate of such a compound, its salt or its prodrug.

100
Another preferred embodiment of the invention is a compound of formula 1 wherein the optionally substituted aliphatic group, optionally substituted cyclic group or optionally substituted aromatic group of R9 is substituted with at least one heteroaryl substituent.
Another preferred embodiment of the invention is a compound of formula 1 wherein the optionally substituted aromatic group of R9 is optionally substituted heteroaryl.
Another preferred embodiment of the invention is a compound of formula 1 wherein the optionally substituted aliphatic group of R9 is optionally substituted alkylheteroaryl.
Another preferred embodiment of the invention is a compound wherein the optionally substituted heteroary group of R9 is pyrazinyl, tetrazolyl, quinolinyl, imidazolyl, isoxazolyl and pyradonyl, optionally substituted with a ring group substituent.
The compounds of the invention optionally are supplied as salts. Those salts that are pharmaceutically acceptable are of particular interest since they are useful in administering the foregoing compounds for medical purposes. Salts that are not pharmaceutically acceptable are useful in manufacturing processes, for isolation and purification purposes, and in some instances, for use in separating stereoisomeric forms of the compounds of this invention. The latter is particularly true of amine salts prepared from optically active amines.
Where the compound of the invention contains a carboxy group, or a sufficiently acidic bioisostere, base addition salts may be formed and are simply a more convenient form for use; and in practice, use of the salt form inherently amounts to use of the free acid form.
Also, where the compound of the invention contains a basic group, or a sufficiently basic bioisostere, acid addition salts may be formed and are simply a more convenient form for use; and in practice, use of the salt form inherently amounts to use of the free base form.
A preferred embodiment of a method according to the present invention is for treating a patient suffering from an HCV infection or physiological conditions related to the infection comprising administering to the patient a pharmaceutically effective amount of a compound of formula 1.
Another preferred embodiment of a therapeutic method according to the present invention is for treating a patient suffering from an HCV infection or physiological conditions related to the infection comprising administering a pharmaceutically effective amount of a compound of formula 1 in combination with a pharmaceutically effective amount of another anti-HCV therapeutic to the patient.
Another object of the present invention is to provide pharmaceutical compositions comprising, in addition to one or more HCV serine protease inhibitors, one or more interferons exhibiting anti-HCV activity and/or one or more compounds having anti HCV activity, including


101
immunomodulatory compounds such as immunostimulatory cytokines exhibiting HCV antiviral activity, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent.
It is another object of the invention to provide a pharmaceutical composition which is effective, in and of itself, for utilization in a beneficial combination therapy because it includes a plurality of active ingredients which may be utilized in accordance with the invention.
The invention also provides kits or single packages combining two or more active ingredients useful in treating or preventing an HCV infection in a patient. A kit may provide (alone or in combination with a pharmaceutically acceptable diluent or carrier), the compound of formula 1 and the additional active ingredient (alone or in combination with diluent or carrier) other anti-HCV therapeutic.
Compounds of formula 1 may be prepared by the application or adaptation of known methods as used heretofore or described in the literature, or by methods according to this invention herein.
Another object of the present invention is to provide methods of treating or preventing a HCV infection in a patient in need thereof, comprising administering to said patient a pharmaceutically effective amount of a combination of one or more HCV serine protease inhibitors; one or more interferons exhibiting anti-HCV activity; and/or one or more compounds having anti-HCV activity, including immunomodulatory compounds such as immunostimulatory cytokines exhibiting HCV antiviral activity.
Another object of the present invention is the use of one or more HCV serine protease
inlubitors in combination with one or more interferons exhibiting anti-HCV activity and/or one or more compounds having anti-HCV activity, including immunomodulatory compounds such as immunostimulatory cytokines exhibiting HCV antiviral activity, to prepare a medicament for treating or preventing a HCV infection in a patient in need thereof.
A further object of the present invention is a kit or pharmaceutical pack for treating or
preventing HCV infection in a patient, wherein the kit or pharmaceutical pack comprises a plurality of separate containers, wherein at least one of said containers contains one or more HCV serine protease inhibitors, at least another of said containers contains one or more interferons or compounds that induce the production of an inteferon that exhibit anti-HCV activity (alone or in combination with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent), and, optionally, at least
another of said containers contains one or more compounds having anti-HCV activity (alone or in combination with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent), including immunomodulatory compounds such as immunostimulatory cytokines exhibiting HCV antiviral activity.
Yet another object of the present invention is to provide a method of inhibiting hepatitis C virus replication in a cell, comprising contacting said cell, a hepatitis C virus serine protease

102
inhibitor, and optionally an interferon or compounds that induce the production of an interferon that have anti-hepatitis C virus activity.
The amount of the HCV serine protease inhibitor(s), interferon(s), or anti-HCV compound(s) in any of the foregoing applications can be a pharmaceutically effective amount, a suboptimal anti-HCV effective amount, or combinations thereof, so long as the final combination of HCV protease inhibitors), interferon(s), and/or anti-HCV compound(s) comprises a phannaceutically effective amount of compounds that is effective in treating or preventing HCV infection in a patient.
It is a further object of the invention to provide a method for preparing a chiral bicycloprolinate compound that is useful in preparing the compound of formula 1.
Preparation of Compounds of the Invention
The starting materials and intermediates of compounds of the invention may be prepared by the application or adaptation of known methods, for example methods as described in the Reference Examples or their obvious chemical equivalents.
Compounds of the invention may be prepared by the application or adaptation of known methods, by which is meant methods used heretofore or described in the literature, for example those described by R.C. Larock in Comprehensive Organic Transformations, VCH publishers (1989).

A compound of formula 1, wherein the variables and

moiety thereof are as

described herein, may be prepared by treating a compound of formula 2, wherein the variables


103


and
moiety thereof are as described herein, with an appropriate oxidizing agent ana under appropriate conditions. A particular oxidizing agent is DMP reagent. Particular conditions include carrying out the oxidation in an appropriate organic solvent such as dichloromethane at about room temperature.


5 A compound of formula 2, wherein the variables and
moiety thereof are as

described herein, may be prepared by coupling a compound of formula 3, wherein the variables


and
moiety thereof are as described herein, and a compound of formula 4, wherein the




variables thereof are as described herein, with an appropriate coupling agent and under 10 appropriate conditions. Particular coupling agent and conditions include using DIC and HOAt in an appropriate organic solvent such as DMF at about 0°C or using PyBop and DIPEA in an appropriate organic solvent such as dichloromethane at about room temperature.

moiety thereof are as 5, wherein the variable
A compound of formula 3, wherein the variables and
described herein, may be prepared by coupling a compound of formula 5, wherein the variables 15 thereof are as described herein, and a compound of formula 6, wherein P2 is an acid

104


moiety thereof is as described herein, with an appropriate
protecting group and the
coupling agent and under appropriate coupling conditions, followed by an appropriate deprotecting agent and under appropriate deprotecting conditions. Particular coupling agent and conditions include using DIC or DCC and HOAt in an appropriate organic solvent such as DMF or dichloromethane at about 0°C to about room temperature. The deprotecting is carried out using an appropriate deprotecting agent that depends on the nature of the protecting agent, i.e., whether it is removable (labile) under acid, base, or hydrogenation conditions, and other reactive moieties in the compound undergoing deprotection, i.e., a deprotecting agent is chosen to carry out the deprotection without effecting the other reactive moieties unless a concomitant reaction is desired. A particular acid protecting agent is Ci to Cs lower alkyl; more particular methyl. A particular deprotecting agent is an inorganic base such as an alkali hydroxide; more particular NaOH. Particular deprotection conditions encompass carrying out the deprotection in an alcoholic solvent such as methanol or ethanol at about room temperature.
A compound of formula 5, wherein n is 0 and the other variables are as described herein, i.e., compound 5a, may be prepared by deprotecting a compound of formula 7,

105



wherein P2 is an acid protecting group and the other variables thereof are as described herein, with an appropriate deprotecting agent and under appropriate conditions. The deprotecting is carried out using an appropriate deprotecting agent that depends on the nature of the protecting agent, i.e., whether it is removeable (labile) under acid, base, or hydrogenation conditions, and other reactive moieties in the compound undergoing deprotection, i.e., a deprotecting agent is chosen to carry out the deprotection without effecting the other reactive moieties unless a concomitant reaction is desired. A particular acid protecting agent is C1 to C8 lower alkyl; more particular methyl. A particular deprotecting agent is an inorganic base such as an alkali hydroxide; more particular NaOH. Particular deprotection conditions encompass carrying out the deprotection in an alcoholic solvent such as methanol or ethanol at about room temperature.
A compound of formula 7, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein, may be prepared by acylating a compound of formula 8, wherein the variables thereof are as-described herein, with a compound of formula 9, wherein M is a displaceable moiety and the other variables

thereof are as described herein, under appropriate conditions. Particular coupling conditions use DIC or DCC and HOAt in an appropriate organic solvent such as DMF or dichloromethane at

106
about 0°C to about room temperature, or PyBop and DIPEA in an appropriate organic solvent such as DMF or dichloromethane at about room temperature; and preferably the latter conditions. A particular L is carbonyl. A particular M is hydroxy or N-oxysuccinimide.
A compound of formula 5, wherein n is 1 and the other variables are as described herein, i.e., compound 5b, may be prepared by deprotecting a compound of formula 10, wherein P2 is an

acid protecting group and the other variables thereof are as described herein, with an appropriate deprotecting agent and under appropriate conditions. The deprotecting is carried out using an appropriate deprotecting agent that depends on the nature of the acid protecting agent, i.e., whether it is removeable (labile) under acid, base, or hydrogenation conditions, and other reactive moieties in the compound undergoing deprotection, i.e., a deprotecting agent is chosen to carry out the deprotection without effecting the other reactive moieties unless a concomitant reaction is desired. A particular acid protecting agent is Cj to C8 lower alkyl; more particular methyl. A particular deprotecting agent is an inorganic base such as an alkali hydroxide; more particular NaOH. Particular deprotection conditions encompass carrying out the deprotection in an alcoholic solvent such as methanol or ethanol at about room temperature.
A compound of formula 10, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein, may be prepared by acylating a compound of formula 11, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein, with a compound of formula 9, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein,

107

under appropriate conditions. Particular coupling conditions use DIC or DCC and HOAt in an appropriate organic solvent such as DMF or dichloromethane at about 0°C to about room temperature, or PyBop and DIPEA in an appropriate organic solvent such as DMF or dichloromethane at about room temperature; and preferably the latter conditions. A particular L is carbonyl. A particular M is hydroxy or N-oxysuccinimide.
A compound of formula 11, wherein the variables are as described herein, may be prepared by deprotecting a compound of formula 12, wherein P1 is an amine protecting group

and the other variables thereof are as described herein, with an appropriate deprotecting agent and under appropriate conditions. The deprotecting is carried out using an appropriate deprotecting agent that depends on the nature of the amine protecting agent, i.e., whether it is removeable (labile) under acid, base, or hydrogenation conditions, and other reactive moieties in the compound undergoing deprotection, i.e., a deprotecting agent is chosen to carry out the deprotection without effecting the other reactive moieties unless a concomitant reaction is desired. A particular amine protecting agent is Cbz or BOC; more particular Cbz. A particular deprotecting agent is acid such as HC1 or H2/Pd(OH)2; more particular H2/Pd(OH)2. Particular

108
deprotection conditions encompass carrying out the deprotection in an alcoholic solvent such as methanol or ethanol or an alkyl alkanoate solvent such as ethyl acetate at about room temperature. A compound of formula 12, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein, may be prepared by coupling a compound of formula 13, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein, with a compound of formula 14, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein,

under appropriate conditions. Particular coupling conditions use HOAt/DIC and DIPEA in an appropriate organic solvent such as THF at about room temperature.
A compound of formula 4, wherein the variables are as described herein, may be prepared by deprotecting a compound of formula 15, wherein the variables thereof are

as described herein, with an appropriate deprotecting agent and under appropriate conditions. The deprotecting is carried out using an appropriate deprotecting agent that depends on the nature of the amine protecting agent, i.e., whether it is removeable (labile) under acid, base, or hydrogenation conditions, and other reactive moieties in the compound undergoing deprotection, i.e., a deprotecting agent is chosen to carry out the deprotection without effecting the other reactive moieties unless a concomitant reaction is desired. A particular amine protecting agent is

109
Cbz or BOC; more particular Cbz. A particular deprotecting agent is an acid such as HC1 or H2/Pd(OH)2; more particular H2/Pd(OH)2- Particular deprotection conditions encompass carrying out the deprotection in an alcoholic solvent such as methanol or ethanol or an alkyl alkanoate solvent such as ethyl acetate at about room temperature.
A compound of formula 15, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein, may be prepared by coupling a compound of formula 16, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein, with a compound of formula 17, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein,

under appropriate conditions. A particular amine protecting agent is Cbz or BOC; more particular Cbz. Particular coupling conditions use HOBT, PyBop and DIPEA in an appropriate organic solvent such as dichloromethane at about 0°C to about room temperature.
A compound of formula 16, wherein the variables are as described herein may be prepared by deprotecting a compound of formula 18, wherein the other variables thereof are

as described herein, with an appropriate deprotecting agent and under appropriate conditions. The deprotecting is carried out using an appropriate deprotecting agent that depends on the nature of the acid protecting agent, i.e., whether it is removeable (labile) under acid, base, or hydrogenation conditions, and other reactive moieties in the compound undergoing deprotection, i.e., a deprotecting agent is chosen to carry out the deprotection without effecting the other reactive

110
moieties unless a concomitant reaction is desired. A particular amine protecting agent is Cbz. A particular acid protecting agent is Ci to C8 lower alkyl; more particular methyl. A particular deprotecting agent is an inorganic base such as an alkali hydroxide; more particular NaOH. Particular deprotection conditions encompass carrying out the deprotection in an alcoholic solvent such as methanol or ethanol at about room temperature.
A compound of formula 18, wherein R° is a bond and the other variables thereof are as described herein, may be prepared by protecting a compound of formula 20, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein, with a compound of formula 19, wherein the

variables thereof are as described herein, under appropriate conditions. A particular amine protecting agent is Cbz or BOC. Particular coupling conditions use an appropriate organic solvent such as dichloromethane at about 0°C to about room temperature.
A compound of formula 20, wherein R4 is hydrogen and the other variables are as described herein, may be prepared by hydrogenating a compound of formula 21, wherein the


1ll
variables thereof are as described herein, with an appropriate hydrogenating agent and under appropriate conditions. A particular hydrogenating agent is H2/Pd(OH)2. Particular hydrogenating conditions encompass carrying out the hydrogenation in an alcoholic solvent such as methanol or ethanol or an alkyl alkanoate solvent such as ethyl acetate at about room temperature.
A compound of formula 20 wherein R4 is optionally substituted aliphatic and the other variables are as described herein may be prepared by alkylating compound 20' wherein the variables are as described herein with compound 22 (alkylating agent) wherein R4 is optionally substituted aliphatic and Q is a displaceable group such as a halides, tosylates or sulfonates, under appropriate conditions.

Appropriate alkylating agents include aliphatic (halides, tosylates or sulfonates). Appropriate alkylating conditions encompass carrying out to alkylation in an appropriate organic solvent such as an alcoholic solvent, e.g., methanol or ethanol, or etheric solvent, e.g., ether or tetrahydrofuran at about room temparature to about reflux.
A compound of formula 21, wherein the variables are as described herein, may be prepared by alkylating a compound of formula 22, wherein the variable thereof is as described herein, with a compound of formula 23, wherein the R3 s independently are optionally

substituted aliphatic group, optionally substituted cyclic group or optionally substituted aromatic group as described herein, under appropriate conditions. Particular alkylating conditions encompass carrying out the alkylation using a strong base such as potassium f-butoxide in an alcoholic solvent such as methanol or ethanol at about room temperature.

112
A compound of formula 24 wherein the variables thereof are as described herein, may be prepared by effecting a Michael addition on a Michael acceptor of formula 29, wherein the variable thereof is as described herein, with an iminic glycinimide derivative.

Michael additions comprise appropriate aprotic polar solvents, alkali methyl hydroxide bases, and appropriate temperatures. For Michael additions, see Corey, EJ.; Noe, M.C.; Xu, F. Tetrahedron Letter 1998, 39,5347. For the synthesis of chiral phase transfer catalysts, see Corey, E.J.; Noe, M.C.; Xu, F. J. Am. Chem. Soc. 1997,119,12414. Appropriate solvents include DCM, ACN, or THF depending on the reaction conditions. Appropriate bases include CsOH, NaOH, KOH, and LiOH. Appropriate temperatures range from about -78°C to about 0°C, more particularly at about -60°C. Iminic glycinimides useful in the invention are described herein. A preferred iminic glycinimide is N-(diphenylmethylene)glycine tert-butyl ester. In addition, Michael addition conditions may be affected with or without a phase transfer catalyst (PTC) (chiral and nonchiral). A preferred PTC isO-[9] allyl-N-9-anthracenylmethylcinchomdium bromide.
A compound of formula 25, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein, may be prepared by imine cleavage and cyclizing of the compound of formula 24.


113
For cleavage and cyclization procedures, see Javidan, A.; Schfer, K.; Pyne, S. Synlett 1996, 100; Tatsukawa, A.; Dan, M.; Ohbatake, M.; Kawatake, K.; Fukata, T.; Wada, E.; Kanemase, S.; Kakei, S. J. Org. Chem. 1993, 58,4221. Cleavage and cyclizing conditions include the use of polar solvents, acid reagents, and temperatures of about room temperature to about 150°C. Preferred conditions include the use of EtOH, AcONa and NH2OH.HC1, and a temperature of about boiling point for the solvent used.
A compound of formula 26, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein, may be prepared by protecting the amide Of the compound of formula 25, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein, with a suitable amide protecting group such as BOC. Other suitable protecting groups include CBz, -CO2alkyl. Also see, Greene, T.W.; P.G.M. in Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis, Wiley, New York, 1991 for other amine protecting groups. Protecting conditions include the use of aprotic polar solvents, organic bases as catalysts, and temperatures of about 0°C-100°C. Preferred conditions include the use of ACN, dimethyl amino pyridine, and a temperature of about room temperature.

A compound of formula 27, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein, may be prepared by reducing the protected compound of formula 26, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein.

Two reductions are, in fact, done. The first reduction is of the amide to a hemiaminal using DIBALH or superhydride [LiBEt3H]. The second reduction is of the hemiaminal to the amine using Et3SiH and BF3'OEt2. See Collado, I; Ezquerra, J.; Mateo, A.I.; Rubio, A., J. Org. Chem.

114
1998, 63 1995-2001 and Ezqueera, J.; Pedrcgal, C; Yruretagoyena, B.; Rubio, A.; Carreno, M.C.; Escribano, A.; Garcia Ruano, J.L. J. Org. Chem. 199S, 60,2925 for reducing conditions.. Other usual conditions for converting pyroglutamates into pyrrolidines is the use of BH3# SMe2.
A compound of formula 28, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein, may be prepared by deprotecting the compound of formula 27, wherein the variables thereof are as described herein.

See Gibson, F.G.; Bermeier, S.C.; Rapopon, H., J. Org Chem. 1994, 59, 3216-3218 for the conditions for selective removal of N-BOC protecting group in the presence of tert-butyl ester. One skilled in the art would know that the deprotecting conditions will be dependent upon the choice of the protecting group. For example, if CBz is used, hydrogenation or basic conditions may be used. Preferably, if BOC is used, 1 N HO in ethyl acetate may be used. See, Greene, T.W.; P.G.M. in Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis, Wiley, New York, 1991.
The person of ordinary skill in the art will appreciate that a compound of formula 3 may be prepared by coupling a compound of formula 5 with a compound of formula 28 under conditions described above herein.
Methods for preparing R3, R5 or R7 as optionally substituted ethanediyl moieties include those known to those skilled in the art, e.g., those methods described in "The organic Chemistry of p-Lactams" edited by G. Georg, VCH Publishers, Inc. (1993), e.g., pages 240-241 and 303-305.
Schemes 1-11 that follow exemplify assorted methods for preparing an optionally substituted multicyclic azaheterocyclyl. The methods in the schemes below are also applicable to other optionally substituted multicyclic azaheterocyclyls comprising compatible like substituents.

115
SCHEME 1


116
SCHEME 3


117 SCHEME 6


118
Scheme 9


119 SCHEME 10


120 Scheme 11

A compound of formula 1 including a group containing one or more nitrogen ring atoms, 5 preferably imine (=N-), may be converted to the corresponding compound wherein one or more nitrogen ring atoms of the group are oxidized to an N-oxide, preferably by reacting with a peracid,

121
for example peracetic acid in acetic acid or m-chloroperoxybenzoic acid in an inert solvent such as dichloromethane, at a temperature from about room temperature to reflux, preferably at elevated temperature.
In the reactions described hereinafter it may be necessary to protect reactive functional groups, for example hydroxy, amino, imino, thio or carboxy groups, where these are desired in the final product, to avoid their unwanted participation in the reactions. Conventional protecting groups may be used in accordance with standard practice, for examples see T.W. Green and P.G.M. Wuts in "Protective Groups in Organic Chemistry" John Wiley and Sons (1991); J.F.W. McOmie in "Protective Groups in Organic Chemistry" Plenum Press, 1973.
A compound that is prepared as described herein may be recovered from the reaction mixture by conventional means. For example, the compounds may be recovered by distilling off the solvent from the reaction mixture or, if necessary after distilling off the solvent from the reaction mixture, pouring the residue into water followed by extraction with a water-immiscible organic solvent and distilling off the solvent from the extract Additionally, the product can, if desired, be further purified by various well techniques, such as recrystallization, reprecipitation or the various chromatography techniques, notably column chromatography or preparative thin layer chromatography.
According to a further feature of the present invention, compounds of the invention may be prepared by interconversion of other compounds of the invention.
As an example of the interconversion process, compounds of formula 1 containing sulphoxide linkages may be prepared by the oxidation of corresponding compounds containing -S- linkages. For example, the oxidation may conveniently be carried out by means of reaction with a peroxyacid, e.g., 3-chloroperbenzoic acid, preferably in an inert solvent, e.g., dichloromethane, preferably at or near room temperature, or alternatively by means of potassium hydrogen peroxomonosulphate in a medium such as aqueous methanol, buffered to about pH 5, at temperatures between about 0°C and room temperature. This latter method is preferred for compounds containing an. acid-labile group.
As another example of the interconversion process, compounds of formula 1 containing sulphone linkages may be prepared by the oxidation of corresponding compounds containing -S-or sulphoxide linkages. For example, the oxidation may conveniently be carried out by means of reaction with a peroxyacid, e.g., 3-chloroperbenzoic acid, preferably in an inert solvent, e.g., dichloromethane, preferably at or near room temperature.
It will be understood that designation of aromaticity with respect to aryls and heteroaryls herein includes any highly resonant unsaturated ring structure. Alternatively, placement of double bonds, where indicated, represents one potential structure for the depicted compound but will be

122
understood to include other resonant states of the compound as well as protonated and charged species, only one of which may be shown.
It will be appreciated that compounds of the present invention may contain asymmetric centers. These asymmetric centers may independently be in either the R or S configuration. It will be apparent to those skilled in the art that certain compounds of the invention may also exhibit geometrical isomerism. It is to be understood that the present invention includes individual geometrical isomers and stereoisomers and mixtures thereof, including racemic mixtures, of compounds according to the invention. Such isomers can be separated from their mixtures, by the application or adaptation of known methods, for example chroraatographic techniques and recrystallization techniques, or they are separately prepared from the appropriate isomers of their intermediates.
For the purpose herein it is understood that tautermeric forms are included in the recitation of a given group, e.g., thioxo/mercapto or oxo/hydroxyl.
Acid additional salts are formed with the compounds of the invention in which a basic function such as an amino, alkylamino, or dialkylamino group is present. The pharmaceutically acceptable, i.e., nontoxic, acid addition salts are preferred. The salts chosen are chosen optimally to be compatible with the customary pharmaceutical vehicles and adapted for oral or parenteral administration. Acid addition salts of the compounds of this invention may be prepared by reaction of the free base with the appropriate acid, by the application or adaptation of known methods. For example, the acid addition salts of the compounds of this invention may be prepared either by dissolving the free base; in water or aqueous alcohol solution or other suitable solvents containing the appropriate acid and isolating the salt by evaporating the solution, or by reacting the free base and acid in an organic solvent, in which case the salt separates directly or can be obtained by concentration of the solution. Some suitable acids for use in the preparation of such salts are hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, phosphoric acid, sulfuric acid, various organic carboxylic and sulfonic acids, such as acetic acid, citric acid, propionic acid, succinic acid, benzoic acid, tartaric acid, fumaric acid, mandelic acid, ascorbic acid, malic acid, methanesulfonic acid, toluenesulfonic acid, fatty acids, adipate, alginate, ascorbate, aspartate, benzenesulfonate,. benzoate, cyclopentanepropionate, digluconate, dodecylsulfate, bisulfate, butyrate, lactate, laurate, lauryl sulfate, malate, hydroiodide, 2-hydroxy-ethanesulfonate, glycerophosphate, picrate, pivalate, pamoate, pectinate, persulfate, 3-phenylpropionate, thiocyanate, 2-naphthalenesulfonate, undecanoate, nicotinate, hemi sulfate, heptonate, hexanoate, camphorate, camphersulfonate, and oThers.
The acid addition salts of the compounds of this invention can be regenerated from the salts by the application or adaptation of known methods. For example, parent compounds of the

123
invention can be regenerated from their acid addition salts by treatment with an alkali, e.g., aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution or aqueous ammonia solution.
Compounds of this invention can be regenerated from their base addition salts by the application or adaptation of known methods. For example, parent compounds of the invention can be regenerated from their base addition salts by treatment with an acid, e.g., hydrochloric acid.
Base addition salts may be formed where the compound of the invention contains a carboxy group, or a sufficiently acidic bioisostere. The bases which can be used to prepare the base addition salts include preferably those which produce, when combined with the free acid, pharmaceutically acceptable salts, that is, salts whose cations are non-toxic to the patient in pharmaceutical doses of the salts, so that the beneficial inhibitory effects inherent in the free base are not vitiated by side effects ascribable to the cations. Pharmaceutically acceptable salts, including those derived from alkali and alkaline earth metal salts, within the scope of the invention include those derived from the following bases: sodium hydride, sodium hydroxide, potassium hydroxide, calcium hydroxide,, aluminum hydroxide, lithium hydroxide, magnesium hydroxide, zinc hydroxide, ammonia, ethylenediamine, N-methyl-glucamine, lysine, arginine, omithine, choline, N.N'-dibenzylethylenediamine, chloroprocaine, diethanolamine, prbcaine, N-benzylphenethylamine, diethylamine, piperazine, tris(hydroxymethyl)-aminomethane, tetramethylammonium hydroxide, and the like.
Compounds of the present invention may be conveniently prepared, or formed during the process of the invention, as solvates (e.g., hydrates). Hydrates of compounds of the present invention may be conveniently prepared by recrystallization from an aqueous/organic solvent mixture, using organic solvents such as dioxan, tetrahydrofuran or methanol.
The starting materials and intermediates may be prepared by the application or adaptation of known methods, for example methods as described in the Reference Examples or their obvious chemical equivalents.
The compounds of the invention, their methods or preparation and their biological activity will appear more clearly from the examination of the following examples which are presented as an illustration only and are not to be considered as limiting the invention in its scope.
Samples were analyzed by IXC, NMR, RP-HPLC or EA.

124
The compounds of the invention, their methods or preparation and their biological activity will appear more clearly from the examination of the following examples which are presented as an illustration only and are not to be considered as limiting the invention in its scope. Samples were analyzed by TLC, NMR, RP-HPLC or EA.
Example 1 - Compounds A-E:
To a DCM solution (10 niL) of compound xi (310 mg, 0.39 mmol) is added TFA (4 mL). The reaction is stirred at about room temperature for 5 hours. At this point, the solvent is removed in vacuo. The resulting residue is purified by reverse phase HPLC to give 195 mg (68%) of compound A,

Following the above method and using the appropriate starting materials, the following consecutive compounds B-E are prepared:



125
Example 2 - Compounds F-M:
To a DCM solution (10 mL) of compound xii (350 mg, 0.56 ramol) is added DMP reagent reagent (307 mg, 0.73 mmol). .The reaction is stirred at about room temperature for 2 hours and then quenched with 10% Na2SO3 for 30 minutes. The reaction mixture is then extracted with EtOAc (75 mL) and washed with brine. The organic layer is dried and concentrated in vacuo. The resulting residue is purified with silica gel chromatography (80-90% EtOAc/Hexanes) to give 248 mg (71%) of compound F

Following the above method and using the appropriate starting materials, the following consecutive compounds G-M are prepared:


126

Example 3 - Compounds N-R:
To a DCM solution (4 mL) of compound xix (-0.22 mmol) is added DMP reagent reagent (146 mg, 0.34 mmol). After stirring at about room temperature for 2 hours, the reaction is quenched with 10% Na2SO3. The reaction mixture is then diluted with DCM. The organic layer is separated and washed with 10% Na2SO3 twice and brine. The resulting organic layer is dried and concentrated in vacua to give a residue, which is purified by silica gel chromatography (5% EtOH/EtOAc) to provide 78 mg (56%) of the desired compound N


127
Following the above method and using the appropriate starting materials, the following consecutive compounds O-R are prepared:

Example 4 - Compounds S-W:
To a DCM solution (10 mL) of compound xxv (320 mg, 0.5 mmol) is added DMP reagent reagent (272 mg, 0.65 mmol). The reaction is stirred at about room temperature for 2 hours and quenched with 10% Na2SO3 for 20 minutes. The resulting mixture is then extracted with EtOAc. The organic layer is washed with brine, dried and concentrated in vacuo. The resulting residue is purified by silica gel chromatography (80% EtOAc/Hexanes) to give 170 mg (53%) of compound S,

128

Following the above method and using the appropriate starting materials, the following consecutive compounds T-W are prepared:

Example 5 - Compounds X-AD:
To a DCM solution (20 mL) of compound xxvi (400 mg, 0.6 mmol) is added DMP reagent reagent (329 mg, 0.78 mmol). The reaction is stirred at about room temperature for 1.5 hours and quenched with 10% Na2SO3 for 20 minutes. The resulting mixture is then extracted with EtOAc. The organic layer is washed wilh brine, dried and concentrated in vacuo. The resulting residue is purified by silica gel chromatography (70-100% EtOAc/Hexanes) to give 210 mg (53%) of compound X,


129
Following the above method and using the appropriate starting materials, the following consecutive compounds Y-AD are prepared:



130
Example 6 - Compounds AE-AI:
Compound xxxiii (150 mg; 0.076 mmol) is dissolved in 5 mL TFA and stirred for two days. The product is purified by RP-HPLC to yield 40 mg (33% yield) of compound AE,

Following the above method and using the appropriate starting materials, the following consecutive compounds AF-AI are prepared:


131

Example 7 - Compound AJ:
Compound xxxviii (180 mg, 0,21 mmol) is dissolved in neat TFA (5 mL) and left for 3 day at about room temperature. At this point, the reaction mixture is concentrated in vacuo to give a residue, which is purified by reverse phase HPLC to give 50 mg (32%) of the compound AJ,

Example 8 - Compounds AK-AM:
Compound xxxxiii (150 mg; 0.16 mmol) is dissolved in 4.5 mL TFA and stirred for three days. The product is purified by RP-HPLC to yield 70 mg (54% yield) compound AK,

Following the above method and using the appropriate starting materials, the following consecutive compounds AL-AM are prepared:


132
Example 9 - Compounds AN:
Compound lii (80 mg) is dissolved in 3 mL TFA and 3 mL DCM. The mixture is stirred at about room temperature for 5 hours. The solvent is removed by evaporation. The resulting residue is purified by HPLC to yield 62 mg (83%) of compound AN,

Example 10 - Compounds AO:
Compound liii (160 mg; 0.2 mmol) is dissolved in 5 mL DCM and DMP reagent reagent (170 mg; 0.4 mmol) is added. The mixture is stirred at about room temperature for three hours. The solvent is removed by evaporation and the residue is dissolved in 50% acetonitrile/water and purified by RP-HPLC to yield 51 mg (32%) of compound AO,


133
Example 11 - Compounds AP:
Compound lix (162 mg; 0.22 mmol) is dissolved in 8 mL of DCM and DMP reagent reagent (189 mg; 0.44 mmol) is added. The mixture is stirred at about room temperature for 3 hours. The solvent is removed by evaporation and product is purified by RP-HPLC to yield 41 mg (25%) of compound AP,

Example 12 - Compounds AQ:
Compound lx (70 mg; 0.09 mmol) is dissolved in 5 mL TFA and 5 mL DCM. The mixture is stirred at about room temperature for 3 hours. The solvent is removed by vacuum and the residue is dissolved in 50% acetonitrile/water and Iyophilized to yield compound AQ as a powder,

Example 13 - Compounds AR-BG:
Compound lxvi (223 mg, 0.326 mmol) is stirred in a solution of TFA (5 mL) and DCM (5 mL) for 4 hours. TLC (silica gel: 2% MeOH/EtOAc) showed complete conversion to the slower product The solvent is removed under reduced pressure and the product Iyophilized to give 198 mg (97%) compound AR,

134

Following the above method and using the appropriate starting materials, the following consecutive compounds AS-BG are prepared:


135



136
Example 14 - Compounds BH-BS:
Compound lxxiii (150 mg, 0.15 mmol) is taken up in DCM (3 mL). To this solution is added TFA (1.5 mL). The resulting solution is stirred overnight. At this point, the reaction is

137
concentrated in vacuo to give a residue. The residue is purified by reverse phase HPLC and lyophilized to give 60 rag (50%) of compound BH,

Following the above method and using the appropriate starting materials, the following consecutive compounds BI-BS are prepared:


138


139
Following the method of Example 12 and using the appropriate starting materials, the following consecutive compounds BT-BU are prepared:

Example 16 - Compound BV:
To a dichloromethane solution (4.2 mL) of compound lxxvii (143 mg, 0.21 mmol) is added DMP reagent reagent (165 mg, 0.39 mmol). The reaction is stirred at about room temperature for 2 hours and quenched with 10% Na2SO3 (aq.) for 20 minutes. The resulting mixture is extracted with EtOAc. The organic layer is washed with brine, dried over MgSO4 and concentrated to a yellow oil. Purification by silica gel chromatography (5% EtOH/EtOAc) yielded 124 mg (79%) of compound BV,

Example 17 - Compounds BW-CA:
To a dichloromethane solution (20 mL) of compound lxxxix (420 mg, 0.62 mmol) is added DMP reagent reagent (342 mg, 0.81 mmol). The reaction is stirred at about room temperature for 1 hour and quenched with 10% Na2SO3 for 20 minutes. The resulting mixture is then extracted with EtOAc. The organic layer is washed with brine, dried and concentrated HI

140
vacuo. The resulting residue is purified by silica gel chromatography (80% EtOAc/Hexanes) to give 208 mg (50%) of compound B W,

Following the above method but using the appropriate starting materials, the following consecutive compounds BX-CA are prepared:

Example 18 - Compounds CB-CC:
To a dichloromethane solution (6.5 mL) of compound lxxxvii (200 mg, 0.3 mmol) is added DMP reagent reagent (227 mg, 0.54 mmol). The reaction is stirred at about room

141
temperature for 2 hours and quenched with 10% Na2SO3 (aq.) for 20 minutes. The resulting mixture is extracted with EtOAc. The organic layer is washed with brine, dried overMgSQi and concentrated to a yellow oil. Purification by silica gel chromatography (5% EtOH/EtOAc) yields 138 mg (70%) of compound CB,

Following the above method but using the appropriate starting materials, the following compound CC is prepared:

Example 19 - Compound CD:
Compound Ixxxxviii (40 mg, 0.05 mmol) is taken up in TFA (3 mL). The solution stirred over two nights and is concentrated. The residue is purified on reverse phase HPLC to give 25 mg (74%) of compound CD,

Example 20 - Compound CE:
Following the method of Example 17 and using the appropriate starting materials, the following compound CE is prepared:


142
Following the method of Example 14 and using the appropriate starting materials, the following consecutive compounds CF-CG are prepared:

Example 22 - Compound CH:
Following the method of Example 16 and using the appropriate starting materials, the following compound CH is prepared:

Example 23 - Compounds Cl-CM
Compound cxi (490 mg, 0.75 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (6 mL). DMP reagent reagent (380 mg, 0.9 mmol) is added to this solution and stirred 1 hour. The reaction mixture is quenched with a 10% Na2SO3 solution, and then the organic phase is washed with saturated NaHCO3 and brine. Following the concentration of the organic phase, the resultant residue is chromatographically purified by 70% EtOAc/hexanes to yield compound CI (325 mg, 66.4%).

143

Following the above method for preparing the above compound and methods related to preparing the intermediate thereto, but using the appropriate starting materials the following consecutive compounds CJ-CM are prepared:


144

Example 24 - Compounds CN
To a DCWTHF solution (3 mLV3 niL) of compound cxviii (335 mg, 0.46 mmol) is added DMP reagent reagent (300 mg, 0.69 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred at room temperature for 2 hours and quenched with 10% Na2SO2i (aq.) for 20 minutes. The resulting mixture is extracted with EtOAc. The organic phase is washed with brine, dried over MgSO4 and concentrated to yield a yellow oil. Purification by silica gel chromatography (80% EtOAc/hexanes) yields compound CN (220 mg, 67%).

Example 25 - Compounds CO-CR
To a DCM/THF solution (1.5 mL/1.5 mL) of compound cxix (164 mg, 0.25 mmol) is added DMP reagent reagent (159 mg, 0.38 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred at room' temperature for 2 hours and quenched with 10% Na2SC3 (aq.) for 20 minutes. The resulting mixture is extracted with EtOAc. The organic phase is washed with brine, dried over MgSO4 and concentrated to yellow oil. Purification by silica gel chromatography (70% EtOAc/hexanes) yields compound CO (100 mg, 61%).


145
Following the above method for preparing the above compound and methods related to preparing the intermediate thereto, but using the appropriate starting materials the following consecutive compounds CP-CR are prepared:

Example 26 - Compounds CS-CT
Compound cxx is dissolved in DCM (3 mL). DMP reagent reagent (180 mg, 0.41 mmol) is added to the solution, and then stirred for 1 hour. The reaction mixture is quenched with 10% Na2SO3, and then the organic phase is washed with saturated NaHCO3 and brine. Following the concentration of the organic phase, the residue is chromatographically purified by 100% EtOAc to yield compound CS (95 mg, 43.7%).

Following the above method for preparing the above compound and methods related to preparing the intermediate thereto, but using the appropriate starting materials the following compound CT is prepared:

146

Example 27 - Compounds CU, El, EK-EM, EO-EZ, and FA-FG
. Compound cxxviii (356 mg, 0.52 raraol) is dissolved in DCM (5 mL). DMP reagent reagent (270 mg, 0.63 mmol) is added to this solution and stirred 1 hour. The reaction mixture is quenched with 10% Na2SO3, and then the organic phase is separated and washed with saturated NaHCO3 and brine. Following the concentration of the organic solvent, the residue is chromatographically purified by 100% EtOAc to yield compound CU (200 mg, 56.3%). mp 225-235° C.

Following the above method for preparing the above compound and methods related to preparing the intermediate thereto, but using the appropriate starting materials the following consecutive compounds El, EK-EM, EO-EZ and FA-FH are prepared:


147


148


149


150


151


152


153

Example 28 - Compounds CV-DC
Compound cxxx (330 mg, 0.46 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (5 mL). DMP reagent reagent (240 mg, 0.56 mmol) is added to this solution and stirred 1 hour. The reaction mixture is quenched with a 10% Na2SO3, and the organic phase washed with saturated NaHCO3 and brine.
Following the concentration of the organic phase, the resulting residue is chromatographically purified bylOO% EtOAc to yield compound cxxx (280 mg, 85.9%).

Following the above method for preparing the above compound and methods related to preparing the intermediate thereto, but using the appropriate starting materials the following consecutive compounds CW-DC are prepared:


154


155
Example 29 - Compounds DD-DE
To a DCM solution (6 mL) of compound cxxxviii (400 mg, 0.57 mmol) is added DMP reagent reagent (362 mg, 0.85 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred at room temperature for 2 hours and quenched with 10% Na2SO3 (aq.) for 20 minutes. The resulting mixture is extracted with EtOAc. The extracted organic phase is washed with brine, dried over MgSO4 and concentrated to yield yellow oil. Purification by silica gel (70% EtOAc/hexanes) yields compound DD (201 mg, 51%).

Following the above method for preparing the above compound and methods related to preparing the intermediate thereto, but using the appropriate starting materials the following compound DE is prepared:

Example 30 - Compound DF
Compound cxxxxiii (165 mg, 0.24 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (5 mL). DMP reagent reagent (125 mg, 0.29 mmol) is added to the solution and stirred 1 hour. The reaction mixture is quenched with a 10% Na2SO3, and the organic phase washed with saturated NaHCO3 and brine. Following the concentration of the organic phase, the resultant residue is purified chromatographically by 70% EtOAc/hexanes to yield compound DF (108 mg, 65.6%).


156
Example 31 - Compounds DG-DJ
To a solution of compound cil (0.350 g, 0.516 mmol) in DCM (15 mL) cooled by an ice bath is added DMP reagent reagent (0.281 g, 0.671 mmol). The mixture is stirred at room temperature for 2 hours, then quenched with 10% Na2SO3 solution and stirred for 20 minutes. The resulting mixture is extracted with DCM (3x20 mL) and the organic extract is dried (MgSO4). After filtration to remove MgSO4, the filtrate is concentrated and purified by column chromatography (70% Ethyl acetate/Hexanes) to yield the final compound DG (0.265 g, 76%) as white solid.

Following the above method for preparing the above compound and methods related to preparing the intermediate thereto, but using the appropriate starting materials the following consecutive compounds DH-DJ are prepared:


157

Example 32 - Compounds DK-DN
ADCM solution ofcompoundclx (108 mg, 0.123 mmol) is treated with DMP reagent reagent (78 mg, 0.185 mmol). After stirring at room temperature for 1 hour, the reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc (50 mL), and then quenched with 10% Na2SO3. After stirring for 30 minutes, the organic phase is separated and washed with NaHCC>3 and brine. The organic phase is dried and concentrated in vacuo to give a residue that is purified by silica gel chromatography (80% EtOAc/hexanes) to yield compound DK (84 mg, 78%).

Following the above method for preparing the above compound and methods related to preparing the intermediate thereto, but using the appropriate starting materials the following compounds DL-DN are prepared.


15S

Example 33 - Compounds DO-DS
An EtOH solution (10 mL) of compound clxii (174 mg, 0.189 mmol) is hydrogenated using Pd/C (30% eq., 60 mg, 10% palladium content) for 2.5 hours. The catalyst is then filtered off. The resulting filtrate is concentrated in vacuo to yield a residue that is purified by semi-preparative reverse phase chromatography and lyophilized to afford compound DO in 70 % yield.

Following the above method for preparing the above compound and methods related to preparing the intermediate thereto, but using the appropriate starting materials the following consecutive compounds DP-DS are prepared.

159

Example 34 - Compound CW:
Compound clxiii (175 mg, 0.24
mmol) is taken up in DCM (3mL). DMP reagent (120 mg, 0.28 mmol) is added to this solution and stirred 1 hour. The reaction is quenched with a 10% Na2SO3 and washed with saturated NaHCO3 and brine. Purification by 70% EtOAc yields compound CW (134 mg, 75%).
Example 35 - Compounds CY and DT-DX:

160
To a DCM solution (15 mL) of cbcxii (290 rag, 0.43 mmol) is added DMP reagent (239 mg, 0.56 mmol). The reaction is stirred at room temperature for 1 hour and quenched with 10% Na2SO3 for 20 minutes. The resulting mixture is then extracted with EtOAc. The organic layer is washed with brine, dried and concentrated in vacuo. The resulting residue is purified by silica gel chromatography (8-100% EtOAc/Hexanes) to give compound CY (151 mg, 52%).
Following the above method for preparing the above compound and methods related to preparing the intermediate thereto, but using the appropriate starting materials the following consecutive compounds DT-DX are prepared.



161
Example 36 - Compounds DY:
Compound Ixxxv (1.17 mmol) is taken up in DCM (5mL). DMP reagent (545 mg, 1.3 inmol) is added to this solution and stirred 1 hour. The reaction is quenched with a P-Na2SO3 (1.5 mmol/g resin) and stirred one hour. P-TBD scavenger resin* (2.5 mmol/g resin) is added and stirred 45 minutes. The resulting mixture is filtered and purified by 50% EtOAc to give compound DY (440 mg, 50.2% over two steps). ^Reference for P-TBD scavenger resin: J. Parlow et al. Tetrahedron. 55, 6785-6796 (1999).

Example 37 - Compound DZ:
The starting material compound clxxxxi (94 mg, 0.14 mmole) is dissolved in a mixture of THF(10mL)andDCM(20mL). The DMF reagent (118 mg, 0.28 mmol) is then added. After stirring at room temperature for 2 hours. The reaction is dumped in a separatory funnel containing Dri Solv THF (120 mL). The reaction is washed with 10% Na2SO3 (50 mL), and then brine (75 mL). The organic layer is then separated, dried over MgSO4 and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. After chromatography (silica gel: elution with 50% Dri Solv THF/EtOAc, and then 4% MeOH/THF). Fractions are checked by MS. Appropriate fractions are lyopholized to yield compound DZ (38.8 mg, 41%).

162

Example 38 - Compounds EA-EB:
The starting compound clxxxxv (185 mg, 0.26mmol) is dissolved in THF (20 mL). The DMP reagent (219 mg, 0.52 mmol) is then added. After stirring at room temperature for 1 hour. TLC shows complete conversion to ketone (5% MeOH/THF). The reaction is dumped in a separatory funnel containing Dri Solv THF (120 mL). The reaction is washed with 10% Na2SO3 (50 mL), and then brine (75 mL). The organic layer is then separated, dried over MgSO* and solvent removed by reduced pressure to yield a residue that is purified by chromatography (silica gel: elution with 50% Dri Solv THF/EtOAc, and then 4% MeOH/THF) and fractions are checked by UV and MS. The appropriate fractions are lyopholized to yield compound EA (159 mg, 88%).

Following the above method for preparing the above compound and methods related to preparing the intermediate thereto, but using the appropriate starting materials the following compound EB is prepared:

Example 39 - Compounds EC-ED:
To a solution of compound clxxxxviii (0.341 g, 0.503 mmol) in DCM (15 mL) cooled in an ice bath is added DMP reagent (0.277 g, 0.654 mmol). The mixture is stirred at room temperature for 2 hours, then quenched with 10% Na2SO3 solution and stirred for 20 minutes.

163
The resulting mixture is extracted with DCM (3x20 mL) and the organic extract is dried (MgSO4). After filtration to remove MgSO,j, the filtrate is concentrated and purified by column chromatography (70% EtOAc/Hexane) to give compound EC (0.183 g, 54%) as white solid.

Following the above method for preparing the above compound and methods related to preparing the intermediate thereto, but using the appropriate starting materials the following compound ED is prepared:

Example 40 - Compounds EE-EG:
Compound ccii (290 mg, 0.37 mrnol) is taken up in DCM (5 mL). DMP reagent (175 mg, 0.41 mmol) is added to this solution and stirred 1 hour. The reaction is quenched with P-Na2SO3 (1.5 mmol/g resin) and stirred 1 hour. Quenched DMP reagent is scavenged with P-TBD (2.5 mmol/g resin) and stirred 1 hour. The resulting mixture is filtered, rinsed with DCM, before being concentrated to a residue. The resulting residue is purified by 50% EtOAc/Hex to yield compound EE (440 mg, 28%).

Following the above method for preparing the above compound and methods related to preparing the intermediate thereto, but using the appropriate starting materials the following compounds EF-EG are prepared:



164

Example 42 - Compound EJ
Compound ixxxiii (520 mg, 1 mmol) is taken up in DCM (5 mL). PyBOP (624 mg, 1.2 ramol) is added to the above solution £ind stirred for 5 minutes. Compound cdviii (300 mg, 1.2 mmol) in THF (5 mL) is added drop-wise to this solution, followed by DIPEA (0.22 ml, 1.2 mmol). The reaction is stiiTed at room temperature overnight under nitrogen. At this point, the reaction is diluted with EtOAc, washed with saturated NaHCO3, and brine. The organic phase is dried with MgSCXj, filtered, and concentrated to give the crude coupled intermediate cdix.


165
This intermediate cdix (~1 mmol) is taken up in DCM (10 mL). Dess-Martin Periodinane (466 nag, 1.1 mmol) is added to this solution. After stirring for 1 hour at room temperature, the reaction is quenched with a polymer bound Na2SO3 (740 rag, 1.5 mmol DMP/ g resin) and stirred 45 minutes. Then, the reaction mixture is scavenged with polymer bound TBD resin (440 mg, 2.5 mmol DMP/ g resin). The resulting mixture is stirred for 45 minutes and then filtered. Purification is achieved in 5% EtOH/EtOAc to yield compound EJ (245 mg, 32% over 2 steps). Literature reference for the work-up procedure can be found in Tetrahedron 55 (1999) 6785-6796.


166
concentrated. Product was purified by silica gel chromatography (50% to 70% EtOAc/Hexanes) to yield compound EN (220 mg, 53%).

Mass Spectra [M] were obtained for the following compounds as shown in Table 1 below.


167


168


169
High Resolution Mass Spectra (HRMS) of the following compounds were obtained as shown in Table 2.

Intermediate Example 1 - Compound ii
To an ethanol solution (40 mL) of compound i (8.1 g, 24.4 mmol) is added NaBKU

(924 mg, 24.4 mmol) at -10 °C. The reaction is stirred at that temperature for 30 minutes, and then quenched with AcOH (3 mL). The reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc (250 mL), and washed with NaHCO3 and brine. The organic layer is dried and concentrated in vacua to yield a

170
residue that is purified by silica gel chromatography (50% EtOAc/Hexanes) to provide 7.85 g (97%) of compound ii,

Intermediate Example 2 - Compound iii
To a THF solution (70 mL) of compound ii (4.48 g, 13.4 mmol) is added at 0°C of NaH (699 mg, 60%, 17.42 mmol). After stirring at that temperature for 40 minutes, neat Mel (1.25 mL, 20.1 mmol) is added. The reaction is stirred at about room temperature overnight. At this point, the reaction is quenched carefully with saturated solution of NH4Cl at 0°C. The reaction mixture is extracted with Et2O and EtOAc. The organic layer is washed with water, brine and dried with Na2SO4. The organic layer thus obtained is concentrated in vacua to provide the xanthate compound iii,

Intermediate Example 3 - Compound iv
The xanthate compound iii (-13.4 mmol) is dissolved in toluene (100 mL). To this solution is added AIBN (216 mg, 1.34 mmol). The resulting solution is degassed with dry nitrogen and then treated with n-Bu3SnH (5.4 mL, 20.1 mmol). The reaction mixture is heated at 90 °C for 3 hours. At this point, the reaction is cooled to room temperature and concentrated in vacuo. The resulting residue is purified with silica gel chromatogi-aphy (15-20% EtOAc/Hexanes) to provide 2.8 g (66% overall from compound ii) of compound iv,

171

Intermediate Example 4 - Compound v
Toanethanol solution (21 mL) of compound iv (1 g, 3.15 mmol) is added Pd(OH)2/C (655 mg, 20%, 0.95 mmol) under a stream of nitrogen. The resulting reaction mixture is subjected to standard hydrogenation (1.5 atm). After 5 hours, the hydrogen source is removed and the reaction is filtered. The filtrates are concentrated in vacuo to provide the free amine compound v,

Intermediate Example 5 - Compound vi
To a DCM solution (10 mL) of compound vii (629 mg, 1.95 mmol) is added at about

room temperature HOAt (265 mg, 1.95 mmol) and followed by 1 M DCC solution in DCM (1.95 mL, 1.95 mmol). After stirring for 30 minutes, a DCM solution (3 mL) of compound v (1.5 mmol) is added to the above HOAt-activated acid. The reaction is stirred at about room temperature overnight. At this point, the reaction is filtered through Celite. The filtrates are diluted with EtOAc (75 mL) and washed with water and brine. The organic layer is dried and concentrated in vacuo. The resulting residue is purified by silica gel chromatography (70-80% EtOAc/Hexanes) to afford 620 mg (85%) of compound vi,


172
Intermediate Example 6 - Compound viii
To an ethanol solution (10 niL) of compound vi (615 mg, 1.26 mmol) is added 2 N NaOH aqueous solution (1.26 mL, 2.52 mmol). The reaction is stirred overnight at about room temperature and then acidified to pH 3 using Dowex acidic resins. The solids are filtered off and the filtrates are concentrated in vacuo to give a residue that is redissolved in 1:1 CH3CN/H2O. This solution is subjected to lyophilization to provide 495 mg (85%) of compound viii,

Intermediate Example 7 - Compound ix
To a DCM solution (10 mL) of compound viii (230 mg, 0.5 mmol) is added PyBop (417 mg, 0.8 mmol). The reaction is stirred at about room temperature for 30 minutes. To this solution is then added a THF solution (5.25 mL) of compound x (263 mg, 0.75 mmol) and followed by

DIPEA (0.174 mL, 1 mmol). The reaction is stirred at about room temperature overnight and then quenched with water (30 mL) for 30 minutes. The reaction mixture is extracted with EtOAc (100 mL). The organic layer is washed with brine and dried and concentrated in vacuo to afford a residue that is purified via silica gel chromatography (5% EtOH/EtOAc) to give -400 mg (100%) of conipound ix,

173

Intermediate Example 8 - Compound xi
To a DCM solution (10 mL) of compound ix (396 mg, 0.5 mmol) is added DMP reagent reagent (278 mg, 0.65 mmol). The reaction is stirred at about room temperature for 1 hour and then quenched with 10% Na2SO3 for 30 minutes. The reaction mixture is then extracted with EtOAc (75 mL) and washed with brine. The organic layer is dried and concentrated in vacuo. The resulting residue is purified with silica gel chromatography (70% EtOAc/Hexanes) to give 320 mg (81%) of compound xi,

Intermediate Example 9 - Compound xii
To a DCM solution (10 mL) of compound viii (230 mg, 0.5 mmol) is added PyBop (417 mg, 0.8 mmol). The reaction is stirred at about room temperature for 30 minutes. To this solution is then added a THF solution (3.5 mL) of compound xiii (140 me, 0.75 mmol) and

followed by DIPEA (0.174 mL, 1 mmol). The reaction is stirred at about room temperature overnight and then quenched with water (30 mL) for 30 minutes. The reaction mixture is extracted with EtOAc (75 mL). The organic layer is washed with brine and dried and

174
concentrated in vacua to afford a residue that is purified via silica gel chromatography (5% EtOH/EtOAc) to give in quantitative yield compound xii,
xii |
Intermediate Example 10 - Compound i'
To a methanol solution (30 mL) of compound i (5 g, 15.1 mmol) is added (BOC)2O (3.3 g, 15.1 mmol) and H2/Pd(OH)2/C (1.6 g, 10% Pd content). The reaction is stirred at about room temperature for 2 hours and then filtered through Celite twice. The Celite bed is rinsed with DCM. The combined filtrates are concentrated in vacuo to yield an oily residue that is purified by silica gel chromatography (40% EtOAc/Hexanes) to give 3.8 g (85%) of compound i,

Intermediate Example 11 - Compound ii'
To a methanol solution (111 mL) of compound i' (3.7 g, 12.5 mmol) is added at 0°C NaBH4 (0.805 g, 21 mmol). After stirring at 0 °C for 2.5 hours, the reaction solvent is evaporated slowly in vacuo to yield a residue that is diluted with EtOAc. This solution is then washed with water twice. The aqueous layer is extracted with EtOAc. The combined organic layers are dried with MgSO4 and filtered and concentrated in vacuo to yield a residue that is purified with chromatography to provide 3.76 g (99%) of compound ii',

175

Intermediate Example 12- Compound xiv
To a DCM solution (180 mL) of compound ii' (3.76 g, 12.3 mmol) is added at 0 °C DMAP (5 g, 40.1 mmol) and then followed by Tf2O (4 mL, 23.7 mmol). The reaction is stirred at 0 °C for 1 hour and at about room temperature for additional 1.5 hours. The reaction mixture is then washed twice with 5% NaHCO0 and dried with MgSO4- The organic layer thus obtained is concentrated in vacuo to provide the crude triflate. The resulting triflate (2.7 g, 6 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (120 mL). To this solution is added DMAP (2.5 g, 20.5 mmol). The resulting reaction mixture is heated to reflux overnight At this point, the reaction is cooled to room temperature and washed with 5% NaHCOa twice. The reaction mixture is dried with MgSO4 filtered and concentrated in vacuo to yield a brownish oily residue that is purified (1% MeOH/DCM) to give 500 rng (30%) of compound xiv,

Intermediate Example 13 - Compound xv
Compound xiv (500 mg, 1.8 mmol) is dissolved in 4 N HC1 in dioxane (6.75 mL). The reaction is stirred at about room temperature for - 4 hours. At this point, the solvent is removed in vacuo. The resulting residue is titrated with diethylether twice to give in almost quantitative yield the HC1 salt of compound xv,

176

Intermediate Example 14 - Compound xvi
To a THF solution (7 mL) of compound vii (579 mg, 1.8 ramol) is added HOAt (245 mg, 1.8 mmol) and DCC (1.8 mL, 1 M in DCM). A suspension is resulted. After stirring at about room temperature for 15 minutes, a THF solution (6 mL) of compound xv (1.8 mmol) and DIPEA (0.63 mL, 3.6 mmol) is added to the above suspension. Additional DIPEA (0.8 mL) is added later. The reaction mixture is stirred overnight at about room temperature. At that point, the white solids so formed are filtered off. The white solids are rinsed with THF. The combined filtrates and washings are concentrated in vacuo to give the crude product that is purified by silica get chromatography (100% EtOAc) to provide 665 mg (76%) of compound xvi,

Intermediate Example 15 ~ Compound xvii
To an ethanol solution (8 mL) of 7 (665 mg, 1.37 mmol) is added 1 N aqueous NaOH (2.4 mmol) at 0°C. The reaction-is stirred overnight at about room temperature, and then acidified to pH 3 using Dowex acidic resins. The solids are filtered. The resulting filtrates are concentrated in vacuo to give a pale yellow residue that is redissolved in 1:1 CH3CN/H2O and lyophilized to give 467 mg (74%) of compound xvii,

177

Intermediate Example 16 - Compound xix
A DCM solution (4 mL) of compound xvii (100 mg, 0.22 mmol) is treated with PyBop (207 mg, 0.4 mmol) at about room temperature for 20 minutes. At this point, the above solution is treated with a THF solution (2.6 mL) of compound xviii (65 mg, 0.32 mmol), followed by DIPEA

(0.076 mL). After stirring at about room temperature for 7 hours, the reaction is quenched with water. The reaction mixture is diluted with DCM (60 mL). The organic layer is separated and washed twice with brine and dried with MgSO4. Upon filtration, concentrated and silica gel chromatography (5% EtOH/EtOAc), 148 mg (-100%) of compound xix is obtained.

Intermediate Example 17 - Compound xx
To a THF solution (100 mL) of N-Cbz-L-valine (14.4 g, 57.2 mmol) is added HOBT (7.72 g, 57.2 mmol) and EDCI (10.98 g, 57.2 mmol). After stirring at about room temperature for 20 minutes, a THF solution (50 mL) containing tert-L-Leucine methyl ester-hydrochloride (10.4 g, 57.2 mmol) and DIPEA (11.9 mL, 68.7 mmol) is added to the above solution. The reaction is

178
stirring at about room temperature overnight. Upon standard aqueous work-up and silica gel chromatography (30% EtOAc/Hexanes) 14 g (64%) of compound xx is afforded.

Intermediate Example 18 - Compound xxi
To a methanol solution (80 mL) of xx (6.71 g, 17.7 mmol) is added (under a stream of N2) Pd/C (1.88 g, 10% Pd content). The reaction vessel is subjected to hydrogenation (1 atm H2) overnight at about room temperature. At this point, the reaction mixture is filtered through a pad of Celite and concentrated in vacud to provide the corresponding crude free amine for next step. A THF solution of this amine (-17.7 mmol) is added to a THF (46 mL) and DMF (5 mL) solution containing 2-pyrazinecarboxylic acid (2.85 g, 23 mmol), Hobbit (3.12 g, 23 mmol) and EDCI (4.41 g, 23 mmol). To the resulting mixture is then added DIPEA (3.08 g, 17.7 mmol). The reaction is stirred overnight at about room temperature and then quenched with water. The reaction mixture is extracted with EtOAc. The organic layer is washed with brine and concentrated in vacuo to provide a residue that is purified by silica gel chromatography (40-50% EtOAc/Hexanes) to provide 3.9 g (63%) of compound xxi,

Intermediate Example 19 - Compound xxii
To a methanol solution (40 mL) of compound xxi (4.67 g, 13.34 mmol) is added 2 N NaOH (10 mL, 20 mmol). The reaction is stiired at about room temperature for 2 hours. At this time, an additional amount of 2 N NaOH (3.3 mL, 6-67 mmol) is added to the reaction mixture. After stirring at about room temperature overnight, the reaction is acidified to pH 3 using acidic resin. The reaction is then filtered and the filtrates are concentrated in vacuo to yield a residue that is dissolved in 1:1 CH3CN/H2O for lyophilization. 4.15 g (93%) of compound xxii is obtained.

379

Intermediate Example 20 - Compound xxiii
A DCM solution (10 mL) of compound xxii (917 mg, 2.73 mmol) is treated with HOAt (371 mg, 2.73 mmol) and DCC (2.73 mL, 1 M, 2.73 mmol). After stirring for 30 minutes, the reaction mixture is treated with a THF solution (10 mL) of compound v (500 mg, 2.73 mmol). After stirring at about room temperature overnight, the white solids (urea) are filtered. The filtrates are concentrated in vacuo to give a residue that is purified by silica gel chromatography (60-70% EtOAc/Hexanes) to provide 1.06 g (77%) of compound xxiii,

Intermediate Example 21 - Compound xxiv
An ethanol solution (20 mL) of compound xxiii (1.06 g, 2.11 mmol) is treated with 2 N NaOH (2.11 mL, 4.23 mmol). After stirring at about room temperature overnight, the reaction mixture is acidified to pH 3 with acidic resin. The solids are filtered off. The resulting filtrates are concentrated in vacuo to give a residue that is lyophilized to give - 1 g (100%) of compound xxiv,

Intermediate Example 22 - Compound xxv
A DCM solution (10 mL) of compound xxiv (236.7 mg, 0.5 mmol) is treated with PyBop (417 mg, 0.8 mmol). After stirring at about room temperature for 20 minutes, the reaction mixture is treated with a DMF solution (5.6 mL) of compound xiii (139-5 mg, 0.75 mmol), followed by DIPEA (0.174 mL, 1 mmol). After stirring at about room temperature for 8 hours,

180
the reaction is quenched with water and extracted with EtOAc. The resulting organic layer is washed with brine and dried and concentrated in vacuo to give a residue that is purified by silica gel chromatography (5% EtOH/EtOAc) to afford -320 mg (100%) of compound xxv,

Intermediate Example 23 - Compound xxvi
A DCM solution (15 mL) of compound xxiv (355 rag, 0.75 mmol) is treated with PyBop (622 mg, 1.2 mmol). After stirring at about room temperature for 20 minutes, the reaction mixture is treated with a THF solution (10 mL) of compound xxvii' (156 mg, 0.75

mmol), followed by DIPEA (0.26 mL, 1.5 mmol). After stirring at about room temperature overnight, the reaction is quenched with water and extracted with EtOAc. The resulting organic layer is washed with brine and dried and concentrated in vacuo to give a residue that is purified by silica gel chromatography (2% EtOH/EtOAc) to afford -400 mg (80%) of compound xxvi,


181
Potassium Cyanide (4 g, 61.44 mmol) is dissolved in 70 mL water and 200 mL methanol. To the solution 10 g (51.2 mmol) of methyl 5-bromopentanoate is added and the mixture is refluxed overnight. The reaction mixture is concentrated to dryness. To the residue, 100 mL of EtOAc is added to extract the product. The organic is washed with water three times, dried and concentrated to yield 5.37 g (74%) of methyl 5-cyanopentanoate as an oil.
Intermediate Example 25 - Methyl 5-tetrazol-5-yIpentanoate
Methyl 5-cyanopentanoate (4.8 g, 34 mmol) is dissolved in toluene, triethylammonium chloride (14 g, 102 mmol) and sodium azide (6.63, 102 mmol) is added. The mixture is heated to reflux for overnight. The reaction mixture is cooled to room temperature, water is added to extract (3x100 mL) methyl 5-tetrazol-5-ylpentanoate from the organic. To the aqueous phase, concentrate HC1 is added to adjust pH to 2. The product is extracted from the aqueous solution with EtOAc (3x50 mL). The organic is combined, dried and concentrated to yield 4.25 g (68%) of methyl 5-tetrazol-5-ylpentanoate.
Intermediate Example 26 - Methyl 5-[N-(l,l-dimethylbenzyl)tetrazol-5-yl]pentanoate
Methyl 5-tetrazol-5-ylpentanoate (4.23 g, 23 mmol) and trichloroacetic acid (8.69 g, 53 mmol) are dissolved in 50 mL of CHC13. a-Methylstyrene (2.72,23 mmol) is added to the solution dropwise, and the reaction mixture is; allowed to stirred at about room temperature for overnight. The reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc to 200 mL, and organic layer is washed with 10% aqueous KOH and brine. The organic layer is dried, concentrated. The product is purified by flash column chromatography to yield 6.6 g (95%) methyl 5-[N-(l,l-dimethy!benzyl)tetrazol-5-yl]pentanoate.
Intermediate Example 27 - 5-[N-(l,l-dimethylbenzyl)tetrazol-5-yl]pentanoic acid
Methyl 5-[N-(l,l-dimethylbenzyl)tetrazoI-5-yl]pentanoate (6.6 g, 21.8 mmol) is dissolved in methanol (100 mL) and 23 mL of 1 N aqueous NaOH is added. The mixture is stirred overnight and is concentrated to remove methanol. The residue is dissolved in water (100 mL) and the solution is neutralized by adding the same equivalent of 1 N aqueous HCI. The product is extracted with EtOAc (3x50 mL). The organic is dried and concentrated to yield 4.75g (75%) 5-[N-(l, 1 -dimethylbenzyl)tetrazol-5-y]]pentanoic acid.
Intermediate Example 28 - Compound xxviii
5-[N-(l,l-dimethylbenzyl)tetrazoI-5-yl]pentanoic acid (4.75 g, 16.5 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (100 mL), 4.8 g (24.8 mmol) of EDCI and 6 mL of DIPEA are added. To the mixture, N-

182
hydroxylsuccinimide (3.8 g, 33 mmol) is added. The reaction mixture is stirred for three hours at about room temperature. The mixture is diluted with DCM to 200 mL and the solution is washed with water three times. The organic is dried and concentrated to yield 4.79 g (75%) of compound xxviii,

Intermediate Example 29 - Compound xxix
The dipeptide H-Val-Val-OH (3.22 g, 14.9 mmol) is suspended in 50 mL of N,N-dimethylformamide (DMF) arid 4.75 g (12.42 mmol) of compound xxviii is added followed the addition of 3.4 mL (18.63 mmol) of diisopropylethylamine (DIPEA). The mixture is warmed up to 40°C and stirred overnight. The solvent is evaporated under high vacuum. The residue is dissolved in EtOAc and washed with 1 N HCI and brine to yield 5.52 g (91%) of compound xxix,

Intermediate Example 30 - Compound xxx
1.6 g (3.29 mmol) of compound xxix is dissolved in 20 mL of DCM, 3.3 mL of 1 M solution of DCC in THF is added. To the mixture, 500 mg (2.73 mmol) of compound v is added, The mixture is stirred at about room temperature overnight. The mixture is diluted with EtOAc to 100 mL and washed with 1 N HCI, NaHCO3 and brine. Purified by column chromatography (50% EtOAc/hexane) to yield 1.02 g (58%) compound xxx,

183

Intermediate Example 31 - Compound xxxi
Compound xxx (1.02 g, 1.57 mmol) is dissolved in 10 mL MeOH and 2 mL of 1 N aqueous NaOH is added. The mixture is stirred overnight. The methanol is removed by evaporation and the residue is dissolved in water and neutralized with 2 mL HC1. Following extraction with EtOAc, l.OOg (-100%) of compound xxxi is afforded.

Intermediate Example 32 - Compound xxxii
Compound xxxi (300 mg, 0.48 mmol) and PyBop (300 mg, 0.58 mmol) are dissolved in 10 mL DCM. To the solution, compound x (201 mg, 0.58 mmol) is added and then DIPEA (104 µ,l) is added. The mixture is stirred at about room temperature overnight. The reaction mixture is then diluted with EtOAc to 100 mL and washed twice with 1 N HCI, twice with NaHCO3 and thrice with brine. The organic is dried and concentrated. The residue is purified by column chromatography (100% EtOAc) to yield 450 mg (98%) of compound xxxii,

184

Intermediate Example 33 - Compound xxxiii
Compound xxxii 360 mg (0.38 mmol) is dissolved in 8 mL DCM and 240 mg (0.57 mmol) of DMP reagent reagent is added. The mixture is stirred at about room temperature for three hours. The mixture is diluted with EtOAc to 50 mL and washed with brine three times. The product is purified by column chromatography (25% ethanol/EtOAc) to yield 300 mg (83%) of compound xxxiii,

Intermediate Example 34 - Compound xxxiv
To a DCM solution (10 mL) of xxxv (790 mg, 2.80 mmol) is added PyBop (1.7 g,


185
3.36 mmol) and Hobbit (450 mg, 3.36 mmol). The resulting solution is cooled to 0°C and treated with a DCM solution (3 mL) of (s)-a-(4-pyridyl)ethylamine (410 mg, 3.36 mmol). This is followed by the addition of DIPEA (0.5 mL, 3.36 mmol). The reaction is stirred overnight at about room temperature. At this point, the reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc. The whole is washed with saturated NaHCO3 and brine. The organic layer thus obtained is dried and concentrated in vacuo. The resulting residue is purified by silica gel chromatography (5% EtOH/EtOAc) to provide 630 mg (58%) of compound xxxiv,

Note: (s)-a-(4-pyridyl)ethylamine is obtained from its D-tartrate salt by base wash (1 N NaOH) and subsequent EtOAc extraction. The recovery rate is 89%.
Intermediate Example 35 - Compound xxxvi
To a methanol solution (15 mL) of compound xxxiv (630 mg, 1.64 mmol) is added under N2 Pd/C (150 mg, 10% palladium content). The reaction is stirred under H2 overnight. The reaction mixture is filtered through a pad of Celite® 521. The filtrates are concentrated in vacuo to provide 420 mg (~100%) of compound xxxvi,

Intermediate Example 36 - Compound xxxvii
To a DCM solution (3 mL) of compound xxxi (270 mg, 0.43 mmol) is added PyBop (270 mg, 0.52 mmol). This is followed by addition of compound xxxvi (160 mg, 0.64 mmol) and DIPEA (0.09 mL, 0.52 mmol). The reaction is stirred at about room temperature overnight. At this point, the reaction is diluted with EtOAc and washed with 0.1N HC1, followed by saturated NaHCO3 and brine. The resulting organic layer is dried and concentrated to give compound xxxvii (430 mg total mass) for next step

186

Intermediate Example 37 - Compound xxxviii
To a DCM solution (3 mL) of compound xxxvii (370 mg, 0.43 mmol) is added DMP reagent reagent (280 mg, 0.65 mmol). The reaction is stirred at about room temperature for 2 hours and then quenched with 10% Na2SO3. After stirring for 30 minutes, the reaction is extracted with EtOAc. The organic layer is washed with saturated NaHCO3 and brine. The resulting organic layer is dried and concentrated in vacuo to give a residue that is purified by silica gel chromatography (5% EtOH/EtOAc) to provide 180 mg (49% for 2-steps) of compound xxxviii,

Intermediate Example 38 - Compound xxxx
Compound xxix (2.5 g, 5 mmol) is dissolved in 40 mL of DCM, 5.1 mL of 1 M solution ofDCC in THF is added to the solution. To the mixture, 1.08 g (3.53 mmol) of compound xxxix is added. The mixture is stirred at about room temperature overnight.


187
The mixture is diluted with EtOAc' to 100 ml,, washed sequentially with 1 N HC1, NaHCO3 and
brine, and then purified by column chromatography (80% EtOAc/hexane) to yield 2.59 g (95%)
of compound xxxx, '

Intermediate Example 39 - Compound xxxxi
Compound xxxx (2.59g, 3.35 mmol) is dissolved in 20 mL MeOH and 4 mL of 1 N aqueous NaOH is added. The mixture is stirred overnight and then rotary evaporated to leave a residue. The residue is dissolved ir) water and neutralized with 2 mL HC1. The neutralized solution is then extracted with EtOAc to yield 2.49 g (-100%) of compound xxxxi,

Intermediate Example 40 - Compound xxxxii
Compound xxxxi (847 mg, 1.16 mmol) and 724 mg (1.39 mmol) of PyBop are dissolved in 10 mL DCM. To the solution, compound :riii (260 mg, 1.39 mmol) is added and then followed by the addition of DIPEA (209 ^il). The mixture is stirred at about room temperature overnight. The reaction mixture is then diluted with EtOAc to 100 mL and washed twice with 1N HC1, twice with NaHCO3 and thrice with brine. The organic is dried and concentrated. The residue is purified by column chromatography (5% ethanol/EtOAc) to yield 930 mg (86%) of compound xxxxii,

188

Intermediate Example 41 - Compound xxxx:iii
Compound xxxxii (350 mg, 0.38 mniol) is dissolved in 10 mL DCM and 242 mg (0.57 mmol) of DMP reagent reagent is added. The mixture is stirred at about room temperature for three hours. The mixture is diluted with EtOAc to 50 mL and washed thrice with brine. The product is purified by column chromatography (100% EtOAc) to yield 180 mg (51%) of compound xxxxiii,

Intermediate Example 42 - Compound xxxxv
H-Val-Val-OH (5 g, 23 mmol) is suspended in 100 mL DMF, compound xxxxiv

(8.3 g, 27.6 mmol) is added, and then 6.2 mL- (35.5 mmol) of DIPEA is added. The mixture is stirred at 40 °C for two days. The solvent is removed under high vacuum and the residue is dissolved in 100 mL EtOAc and washed thrice with 1 N HC1 and twice with brine. 9.14 g (99%) of compound xxxxv is afforded.

189

Intermediate Example 43 - Compound xxxxvi
Compound xxxxv (2.8 g, 7 mmol) and 954 mg (7 mmol) of HOAt is dissolved in 100 mL DCM. 7 mL of 1 M DCC/DCM is added. To the reaction mixture, compound xxxix (2.15 g) is added and the reaction mixture is stirred at about room temperature for overnight. The mixture is concentrated to dryness and the residue is dissolved in EtOAc and purified by column chromatography (100% EtOAc) to yield 4:57 g (95%) of compound xxxxvi,

Intermediate Example 44 - Compound xxxxvii
Compound xxxxvi (4.57 g, 6.65 mmol) is dissolved in 10 mL TFA and 10 mL DCM. The mixture is stirred at about room temperature for 4 hours. The solvent is removed by vacuum and the residue is dissolved in 50:50 acetoiritrile/water and lyophilized to yield as a powder compound xxxxvii,


190
Intermediate Example 45 - Compound xxxxviii
Compound xxxxvii (1 g, 1.59 mmol) and 990 mg (2.28 mmol) of PyBop is dissolved in 20 mL DCM and 1.6 mL of 1 M methylamme in THF is added. The mixture is stirred at about
ii
room temperature for 4 hours. The reaction imixture is diluted to 100 mL with EtOAc and washed with 1 N HC1, NaHCO3 and brine. The residue is purified by flash column chromatography (10% EtOH/EtOAc) to yield 1 g (98%) of compound xxxxviii,

Intermediate Example 46 - Compound xxxxix
Compound xxxxviii (1 g, 1.55 mmol) is dissolved in 10 mL of MeOH and 2 mL 1 N NaOH is added. The mixture is stirred at about room temperature for overnight. The solvent is removed by evaporation. The residue is dissolved in water, neutralized and extracted with EtOAc to yield 960 mg (98%) of compound xxxxix,

Intermediate Example 47 - Compound li
Compound xxxxix (315 mg, 0.5 mmol) and 312 mg (0.6 mmol) of PyBop are dissolved in 10 mL DCM. Compound 1 (56 mg, 0.6 mmol) and 108 µl of DIPEA is added. The mixture


191
is stirred at about room temperature overnight, and is diluted to 100 mL w;th EtOAc and washed with 1 N HCI, NaHCO3 and brine. Purified by column chromatography (15% EtOH/EtOAc) to yield 400 mg (92%) of compound li,

Intermediate Example 48 - Compound lii
Compound li (400 mg, 0.46 mmol) is dissolved in 10 mL of DCM and 292 mg (0.69 mmol) DMP reagent reagent is added. The mixture is stirred at about room temperature for 3 hours. The solvent is removed by evaporation and product is purified by RP-HPLC to yield 130 mg (32%) of compound lii,

Intermediate Example 49 - Compound liii
Compound xxxxix (210 mg, 0.33 mrnol) and 208 mg (0.4 mmol) of PyBop are dissolved in 10 mL DCM. Compound xiii (154 mg, 0.83 mmol) is added to the solution followed by the addition of DIPEA (72 µl, 0.4 mmol). The mixture is stirred at about room temperature overnight. The reaction mixture is diluted to 100 mL with EtOAc, washed with 1 N HCI, NaHCO3 and brine, and then purified by flash column chromatography (10% EtOH/EtOAc) to yield 250 mg (95%) of compound liii,


192
Intermediate Example 50 - Compound liv
Compound xxxxv (755 mg, 1.88 mmol) and 255 mg (1.88 mmol) of HOAt are dissolved in 20 mL DCM. 1.88 mL of 1 M DCC/DCM is added. To the reaction mixture, compound v (288 mg) is added and the reaction mixture is stirred at about room temperature for 2 hours. The mixture is concentrated to dryness and the residue is dissolved in EtOAc and purified by column cliromatography (80% EtOAc/Hexanes) to yield 800 mg (90%) of compound liv,

Intermediate Example 51 - Compound Iv

Compound liv (800 mg, 141 mmol) is dissolved in 10 mL MeOH and 2 mL NaOH is added. The mixture is stirred at about room temperature overnight. The solvent is removed by vacuum and the residue is dissolved in water and neutralized with 2 mL 1 N HO. The product is extracted with EtOAc. Evaporation of the extraction solvent afforded 760 mg (-100%) lv,

193



Intermediate Example 52 ~ Compound lvii
Compound Iv (760 mg, 1.41 mmol) and 880 mg (1.69 mmol) of PyBop are dissolved in 5 mL DCM. Compound lvi (530 mg, 2.12 mmol) is added to the solution and then 0.31

of DIPEA is added. The mixture is stirred at about room temperature overnight The reaction mixture is diluted to 100 mL with EtOAc, washed with 1 N HC1, NaHCO3 and brine, and then purified by flash column chromatography (100% EtOAc) to yield 870 mg (80%) of compound lvii,

Intermediate Example 53 - Compound Iviii
Compound lvii (350 mg, 0.45 mmol) is dissolved in 5 mL TFA and 5 mL DCM and the mixture is stirred at about room temperature for 3 hours. The solvent is removed by evaporation and the product is purified by RP-HPLC to yield 220 mg (69%) of compound Iviii,

194

Intermediate Example 54 - Compound lix
Compound lviii (200 mg, 0.28 mmol) and 218 mg (0.42 mmol) of PyBop are dissolved in 5 mL DCM. Methylamine (0.28 mL of 2 M in THF) is added. Tlie mixture is stirred at about room temperature overnight. The mixture is diluted to 100 mL with EtOAc, washed with 1 N HC1, NaHCO3 and brine, and then purified by column chromatography (15% EtOH/EtOAc) to yield 168 mg (79%) of Hx,

Intermediate Example 55 - Compound lx
Compound lviii (200 mg, 0.26 mmol) is dissolved in 4 mL of DCM and 165 mg (0.39 mmol) of DMP reagent reagent is added. The mixture is stirred at about room temperature for 3 hours. The solvent is removed by evaporation. The residue is dissolved in 50% acetonitrile/water, and filtered purified by RP-HPLC to yield 140 mg (70%) of compound lx,


195
Intermediate Example 56 - Compound ii
A DCM (30 mL) and EtOH (30 mL) solution of compound i (4 g, 12.1 mmol), under N2, is cooled down to -10° C. NaBKt (458 mg, 12.1 mmol) is added and the solution is stirred at -10° C for 50 minutes. TLC (50% EtOAc/Hexane) showed total conversion to a slower running spot. The reaction is carefully quenched with ice and then with a cold saturated solution of NH4CI (10 mL). The mixture is dumped in DCM (300 mL). The organic layer is washed once with saturated solution of NH4CI (60 mL) and twice with brine (60 mL). The organic layer is then separated, dried over MgSO4 and concentrated in vacuo, to yield 3.5 g of compound ii (87%)
Intermediate Example 57 - Compound lxi
Intermediate Example 58 - Compound lxii
Under inert atmosphere, a solution of compound lxi (200 mg, 1 mmol), compound lxiii,
In a 250 mL round bottom flask equipped with a H2 balloon, an ethanolic solution (50 mL) of compound ii (3.5 g, 10.5 mmol) is subjected to standard hydrogenation conditions [20% Pd(OH)2/C (1.47 g, 2.1 mmol)] for 5 hours at about room temperature. The catalyst is filtered off through Celite and washed with DCM. The solvent is then removed under reduced pressure to yield 2 g (96%) of compound lxi,


(233 rag, 1.1 mmol), HOAt (l-hydroxy-7-azabenzotriazole) (156 mg, 1.15 mmol) in anhydrous DMF (6 mL) is stirred for 20 minutes. The temperature is then taken down to 0°C, followed by the addition of DIC(0.18 mL, 1.15 mmol). The reaction is stirred overnight at about room temperature. The solution is diluted with EtOAc and then washed twice with 1 N HC1, twice with saturated aqueous NaHCO3, and brine. The organic layer is separated dried over MgSOd and the

196
solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue is cleaned by chromatography (silica gel: 70% EtOAc/DCM) to give in 45% yield compound bdi.

Intermediate Example 59 - Compound lxiv
A solution of compound lxii (777 mg, 2 mmol) in dioxane (6 mL) and 0.5 M NaOH (6 mL) is stirred for 5 hours at about room temperature. Examination by TLC (100% EtOAc) shows complete conversion to a spot at the origin. The reaction is cooled down with an ice bath followed by the addition of 1 N HC1 (4 mL). Solid NaCl is then added and the whole mixture is extracted twice with EtOAc (2X150mL). The organic extracts are then combined, dried over MgSO4 and the solvent removed under reduced pressure to give compound lxiv in 92% yield.

Intermediate Example 60 - Compound lxv
Under an inert atmosphere, a solution of compound x (203 mg, 0.58 mmol), compound lxiv (276 mg, 0.775 mmol), HOAt (l-hydroxy-7-azabenzotriazole) (126 mg, 0.93 mmol) in anhydrous DMF (6mL) is stirred for 20 minutes. The temperature is then taken down to 0°C, followed by the addition of DIC (0.14 mL, 0.93 mmol). The reaction is stirred overnight at about room temperature. The solution is diluted with EtOAc and then washed twice with 1 N HC1, twice with saturated aqueous NaHCO3, and brine. The organic layer is separated dried over MgSO4 and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue is purified by chromatography (silica gel: 50%EtOAc/DCM to 80:19:1 EtOAC/DCM/MeOH) to give compound lxv in 62% yield.

197

Intermediate Example 61 - Compound lxvi
Under an inert atmosphere, to a solution of compound lxv (287mg, 0.42 mmol) in anhydrous DCM (15mL) is added the DMP reagent reagent (605mg, 1.43 mmol) The reaction is stirred for 2 hours at about room temperature. (Note.- The doubling of the amount of the DMP reagent reagent and the reaction time is to assure that both alcohol groups are completely oxidized to the corresponding keto groups). Examination by TLC (silica gel: 2% MeOH/EtOAc) shows complete conversion to the faster product. The reaction is diluted with DCM (150 mL) and then washed twice with a 10% aqueous sodium sutfite solution (2X 50mL), twice with saturated aqueous NaHCO3, and with brine. The organic layer is separated dried over MgSO* and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue is purified by chromatography (silica gel: 50% EtOAC/DCM to 80:19:1 EtOAC/DCM/MeOH) to give in 77% yield compound lxvi.

Intermediate Example 62 - Compound lxvii
To a DCM solution (60 ml) of L-3 phenyl lactic acid (2 g, 12 mmol) is added PyBOP (7.5 g, 14.4 mmol). To this solution is added a DCM solution (20 mL) containing L-valine methyl ester HCI (2.4 g, 14.4 mmol) and DIPEA (2.6 mL, 14.4 mmol). The resulting reaction mixture is stirred overnight at about room temperature. At this point, the reaction is diluted with EtOAc (30 mL), washed with NaHCO3 (30 mL) and brine (15 mL). The organic layer is dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated. Purification is achieved in 50% EtOAc/Hex on silica gel to give 2.97 g (89%) of compound lxvii,

198

Intermediate Example 63 - Compound lxviii
Compound Ixvii (2.97 g, 10.6 mmol) is taken up in DCM (50 mL) and cooled with an ice bath. TBSC1 (2.1 g, 13.8 mmol) is added to this solution followed by imidazole (0.94 g, 13.8 mmol). The resulting solution is stirred overnight. The reaction is then diluted with EtOAc (50 mL), washed with NaHCO3 and brine. The organic layer is dried over Na2SC>4, filtered and concentrated. Purification is achieved in 20% EtOAc/Hexane on silica gel to give 3.79 g (90%) of compound lxviii,

Intermediate Example 64 - Compound box
To a methanol (50 ml) solution of compound lxviii (3.78 g, 9.6 mmol) is added 1 N aqueous NaOH (14.4 mL, 14.4 mmol). The resulting solution is stirred overnight. The solvent is partially removed in vacuo. The pH of the reaction mixture is then lowered to 3 using 1 N HC1 aqueous solution. The solution is diluted with EtOAc and brine. The desired product is extracted with EtOAc (3x5Oml). The organic layers are combined, dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated to give 3.5 g (96%) of compound lxix,

Intermediate Example 65 - Compound lxx
To a DCM (15 mL) solution containing compound lxix (1.1 g, 2.9 mmol) is added HOAt (0.44 g, 3.2 mmol) followed by a 1 M solution of DCC (3.2 mL, 3.2 mmol) in DCM. After stirring at about room temperature for 20 minutes, a DCM (15 mL) solution of compound xxxix (970 mg, 3.2 mmol) is added. This reaction is stirred overnight under N2. The reaction is then diluted with EtOAc (30 mL), filtered through a pad of silica gel, washed with 0.1 N HCI,

199
NaHCO3, and brine. The organic layer is dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. Purification is achieved in 50% EtOAc/Hex on silica gel to give 1.5 g (77%) of compound lxx,

Intermediate Example 66 - Compound lxxi
To a methanol solution (30 mL) of compound xx (1.5 g, 2.4 mmol) is added 1 N aqueous NaOH (3.6 mL, 3.6 mmol). The resulting solution stirred overnight. At this point, the solvent is partially removed, and the pH of the reaction mixture is adjusted to 3 using 1 N aqueous HCI. The reaction is then diluted with EtOAc (50 mL) and brine (20 mL). The aqueous layer is extracted with EtOAc (3x50mL). The organic layers are combined, dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated to provide 1.3 g (92%) of compound lxxi,

Intermediate Example 67 - Compound lxxii
To a solution of DCM (2 mL) containing compound lxxi (180 mg, 0.28 mmol) is added PyBOP (175 mg, 0.34 mmol) and DIPEA (0.06 mL, 0.34 mmol), followed by a DCM solution (3 mL) of compound x (150 mg, 0.41 mmol). The resulting solution is stirred overnight under N2. The reaction is then diluted with EtOAc (30 mL), washed with NaHCO3 and brine. The organic layer is dried over Na2SCO4, filtered and concentrated. Purification is achieved in 100% EtOAc on silica gel to give 270 mg (98%) of compound lxxii.

200

Intermediate Example 68 - Compound lxxiii
To a DCM (3 mL) solution of compound lxxii (270 mg, 0.27 mmol) is added DMP reagent reagent (140 mg, 0.33 mmol). After stirring at about room temperature for 1.5 hours, the reaction is quenched with 10% Na2SO3 (10 mL). The reaction is diluted with EtOAc (30 mL) and stirred for 10 minutes. The organic layer is washed with NaHCO3 and brine. The organic layer is dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated. Purification is achieved in 60% EtOAc/Hex. to give 150 mg (56%) of compound lxxiii,

Intermediate Example 69 - Compound lxi
To an ethanol solution (50 mL) of compound ii (3.5 g, 10.5 mmol) is added under a stream of nitrogen Pd(OHVC (1.47 g, 20% Pd content, 2.1 mmol). The reaction is subjected to hydrogenation under 1 atm pressure. Upon completion, the catalysts are filtered through a pad of Celite and washed with dichloromethane. The filtrates are concentrated in vacuo to give 2 g (96%) of compound lxi.

201
Intermediate Example 70 - Compound lxxiv
To a DMF solution (60 mL) of compound vii (9.1 g, 28.2 mmol) is added HOAt (4 g, 29.4 mmol) and 1,3-disiopropylcarbodiimide (3.7 g, 29.4 mmol). After stirring at about room temperature for 30 minutes, a DMF solution (10 raL) of compound lxi (5.1 g, 25.6 mmol) is added to the above solution. The reaction is stirred at about room temperature overnight. At this point, the white solids are filtered off. The filtrates are concentrated in vacuo to give a residue that is purified by silica gel chromatography to give 9.5 g (67%) of compound lxxiv,

Intermediate Example 71 - Compound Ixxv
To a solution of compound lxxiv (1.5 g, 3 mmol) in anhydrous THF (25 mL) is added EtiPrjN (0.78 mL, 4.5 mmol) at about room temperature. The mixture is cooled to 0°C and MOMC1 (1.5 mL, 19.7 mmol) is added in a dropwise fashion. The reaction is allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred overnight. The solution is then diluted with ether and washed with water (3 times). The aqueous layers are extracted further by ether and all the organic layers are dried over MgSCX* before being concentrated to afford a yellow oil. The desired isomer of compound Ixxv is isolated by silica gel chromatography (EtOAc/Hexanes

5/2) in 40% yield with clear separation of diastereomers.
Intermediate Example 72 - Compound lxxvi
To a solution of compound Ixxv (502 mg, 0.9 mmol) in EtOH (5 mL) is added 2 N aqueous NaOH (0.9 mL, 1.8 mmol) dropwise at 0°C. The reaction is allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred overnight. Upon completion of the saponification, the solution is acidified to pH 3 with Dowex 50W8X-200 acidic Tesin. The solids are filtered off and the resulting filtrate is concentrated in vacuo to give a oily residue that is lyophilized to give 370 mg (80 %) compound lxxvi,


202
Intermediate Example 73 - Compound lxxvii
A dichloromethane solution (4 mL) of compound lxxvi (110 mg, 0.21 mmol) is treated with PyBOP (200 mg, 0.38 mmol). After stirring at about room temperature for 30 minutes, the reaction mixture is charged with a THF solution (3.2 mL) of compound xiii (60 mg, 0.32 mmol), followed by EtiPr2N. After stirring overnight at about room temperature, the reaction is quenched with water and extracted with EtOAc. The resulting organic layer is washed with brine and dried over MgSO4, before being concentrated to a yellow oil. Purification by silica gel chromatography (5% EtOH/EtOAc) yields 143me (100%) of compound lxxvii,

Intermediate Example 74 - Compound lxxviii
To a THF solution (50 mL) of H-Chg-OH 2 (5 g, 19.4 mmol) is added HOBt (2.63 g, 19.4 mmol) and EDCI (3.72 g, 19.4 mmol). After stirring at about room temperature for 20 minutes, a THF (19 mL) and DMF (10 mL) solution containing tert-L-Leucine methyl ester-hydrochloride (19.4 mmol) and DIPEA (6.75 mL, 38.8 mmol) is added to the above solution. The reaction is stirred at about room temperature overnight. Standard aqueous work-up and silica gel chromatography (15 - 20% EtOAc/Hexanes) affords 2.27 g (30%) of compound lxxviii,


Intermediate Example 75 - Compound lxxix
To a THF solution (12 mL) of compound lxxviii (2.27 g, 5.91 mmol) is added 4 N HC1 solution in dioxane (7.38 mL, 29.5 mmol). The reaction is stirred at about room temperature overnight. At this point, the solvent is removed under reduced pressure to yield the compound lxxix that is used directly for next reaction.

Intermediate Example 76 - Compound lxxx
To a THF solution of compound lxxix (5.9 mmol) is added to a THF (20 mL) solution containing 2-pyrazinecarboxylic acid (878 mg, 7.08 mmol), HOBt (957 mg, 7.08 mmol) and EDCI (1.36 g, 7.08 mmol). To the resulting mixture is then added DIPEA (2.05 mL, 11.8 mmol). The reaction is stirred overnight at about room temperature and then quenched with water. The reaction mixture is extracted with EtOAc. The organic layer is washed with brine and concentrated in vacuo to provide a residue that is purified by silica gel chromatography (40-50% EtOAc/Hexanes) to provide 1 g (36%) of compound lxxx,

Intermediate Example 77 - Compound lxxxi
To a methanol solution (20 mL) of compound lxxx (1 g, 2.56 mmol) is added 2 N NaOH 3.2 mL, 6.4 mmol). The reaction is stirred at about room temperature overnight. At this point, the reaction is acidified to pH 3 using 5 N HCI. The reaction is diluted with EtOAc (75 mL), and washed with water and brine. The organic layer thus obtained is dried and concentrated in vacuo to give a residue that is dissolved in 1:1 CH3CN/H2O for lyophilization. A total of-1 g (100%) of compound lxxxi is obtained.

204

Intermediate Example 78 - Compound Ixxxii
A dichloromethane solution (10 mL) of compound lxxxi (2.56 mmol) is treated with HOAt (348 mg, 2.56 mmol) and DCC (2.56 mL, 1M, 2.56 mmol). After stirring for 30 minutes, the reaction mixture is treated with a THF solution (5 mL) of compound v (2.56 mmol). After stirring at about room temperature overnight, the white solids (urea) are removed by filtration. The filtrates are concentrated in vacua to give a residue that is purified by silica gel chromatography to provide 1.4 g (100%) of the compound Ixxxii,

Intermediate Example 79 - Compound lxxxiii
An ethanol solution (15 mL) of compound Ixxxii (1.4 g, 2.58 mmol) is treated with 2 N NaOH (2.58 mL, 5.17 mmol). After stirring at about room temperature overnight, the reaction mixture is acidified to pH 3 with acidic resin. The solids are filtered off. The resulting filtrates are concentrated in vacuo to give a residue that is lyophilized to give 1.32 g (-1009&) of compound lxxxiii,


205
Intermediate Example 80 - Compound lxx?av
A dichloromethane solution (15 mL) of compound lxxxiii (360 mg, 0.7 mmol) is treated with PyBOP (582 mg, 1.12 mmol). After stirring at about room temperature for 20 minutes, the reaction mixture is treated with a THF solution (10 mL) of compound xiii (195.6 mg, 1.05 mmol), followed by DIPEA (0.25 mL, 1.40 mmol). After stirring overnight at about room temperature, the reaction is quenched with water and extracted with EtOAc. The resulting organic layer is washed with brine and dried and concentrated in vacuo to give a residue that is purified by silica gel chromatography (3% EtOH/EtOAc) to afford 420 mg (88%) of compound lxxxiv,

Intermediate Example 81 - Compound ii'"
A mixture of anhydrous dichloromethane and ether (20 mL:20 mL) is cooled to -78°C under N2 (g). To the solution is added TiCl4 (1 M in dichloromethane, 10 mL, 10 mmol) and then MeLi (1.4 M in ether, 7.1 mL, 10 mmol) is added subsequently with stirring for another 30 minutes at -78°C. A solution of compound i (2 g, 6 mmol) in 10 mL dichloromethane is added to the mixture dropwise at the same temperature over 15 minutes. The solution is slowly warmed up to -40°C for 10 minutes and then stirred at 0"C for 2 hours. The reaction is quenched by pouring the mixture into a water/ether mixture (1:1) and then the layers are allowed to separate. The aqueous layer is further extracted by ether twice. All organic layers is washed by water, brine and dried over MgSO4 before being concentrated to a yellow oil. The desired compound ii"' is isolated by silica gel chromatography (EtOAc/Hexanes 2/1) in 83%

Intermediate Example 82 - Compound lxi'
To the compound ii'" (1.7 g, 5 mmol) is added to 10 wt %Pd on C (0.53 g, 0.5 mmol), followed by addition of MeOH (17 mL). Hydrogen gas is flushed through the reaction mixture and hydrogen gas is maintained for reaction at 1 atm overnight. The reaction mixture is then filtered and concentrated to afford 929 mg (87%) of compound lxi' as a colorless oil.

206

Intermediate Example 83 - Compound Ixxxv
To a THF solution (16 mL) of compound xxii (1 g, 3 mmol) is added at about room temperature HOAt (0.41 g, 3 mmol) and followed by 1 M DCC solution of dichloromethane (3 mL, 3 mmol). After stirring for 30 minutes at about room temperature, a dichloromethane solution (6 mL) of compound lxi' is added to the above HOAt-activated acid. The reaction is stirred at about room temperature overnight. At this point, the reaction is filtered through Celite. The filtrate is diluted with EtOAc (120 mL) and washed with water and then brine. The organic layer is dried and concentrated to an yellow oil which is purified by silica gel chromatography (100% EtOAc) to yield 1 g (65%) of compound Ixxxv,

Intermediate Example 84 - Compound Ixxxvi
To an ethanol solution (8 mL) of compound Ixxxv (920 mg. 1.7 mmol) is added 2 N NaOH aqueous solution (1.7 mL, 3.4 mmol). The reaction is stirred overnight at about room temperature and then acidified to pH 3 by Dowes acidic resin. The solids are filtered off and the filtrate is concentrated to give a colorless oil, which is redissolved in 1:1 CH3CN/H2O and lyophilized to provide 800 mg (93%) of compound Ixxxvi. HPLC shows a single product peak.

Intermediate Example 85 - Compound lxxtxvii
To a dichloromethane solution (4 mL) of compound Ixxxvi (150 mg, 0.3 mmol) is added by PyBOP (250 mg, 0.47 mmol). The solution is stirred at about room temperature for 30 minutes. To this solution is then added a THF (4.5 mL) solution of compound xiii (84 mg, 0.45 mmol) followed bv EtiPr2N (0.1 mL, 0.6 :mmol). The reaction is stirred at about room

207
temperature overnight and then quenched with water (25 mL) for 30 minutes. The mixture is then extracted with EtOAc. The resulting organic layer is washed with brine and dried over MgSO4, before being concentrated to a yellow oil. Purification by silica gel chromatography (5% EtOH/EtOAc) yields 200 mg (100%) of compound Ixxxvii



Intermediate Example 86 - Compound lxxxix
Compound lxxxviii, N-Cbz-L-Valine, (2.5 g, 9.9 mmol) is taken up in THF (30mL).

EDCI (2.29 g, 11.9 mmol) and HOBT (1.62 g, 11.9 mmol) are added and the mixture stirred five minutes. L-fer/-Leucine methyl ester hydrctchloride (2.17 g, 11.9 mmol) is added in THF (23.9 mL) followed by DIPEA (2.1mL). The reaction mixture is stirred overnight under nitrogen. The reaction mixture is diluted with ethyl acetate, washed with 1 N HC1, saturated sodium bicarbonate, and brine. The organic phase is dried over sodium sulfate, filtered and concentrated. The concentrate residue is purified in 25% ethyl acetate/hexane to afford 1.1 g (29%) of compound lxxxix,

Intermediate Example 87 - Compound lxxxx
Compound lxxxix is hydrolyzed under standard conditions using methyl alcohol (0.3 M) and 1 N NaOH (1.5 eq) to afford 1.03 g (95%) of compound lxxxx,


Intermediate Example 88 - Compound lxxxxi
Compound lxxxx (385mg, 1.06 mraol) is taken up in dichloromethane (3mL). DCC (1.4 mmol) is added followed by HOAt (190 rag, 1.4mmol). Compound v ( 260 mg, 1.4 mmol) is then added in dichloromethane (3 mL). The resulting mixture is stirred overnight under nitrogen. The reaction is diluted with ethyl acetate, filtered through silica gel, and concentrated. The residue is purified in 50% ethyl acetate / hexane to afford 440 mg (80%) of compound lxxxxi,

Intermediate Example 89 - Compound Ixxxxii
Compound lxxxxi is hydrolyzed under standard conditions using ethyl alcohol (0.3 M) and 1 N NaOH (l.Seq) to afford 390 mg of compound lxxxx.ii,

Intermediate Example 90 - Compound Ixxxxiii
Compound lxxxxii (350 mg, 0.7 mmol) is taken up in dichloromethane (3mL). PyBOP (480 mg, 0.91 mmol) is added followed by compound xiii (170 mg, 0.91 mmol). DIPEA (0.16 mL, 0.91mmol) is added and reaction mixture stirred overnight. The reaction mixture is concentrated and purified in 100% ethyl acetate to afford 420 mg (90%) of compound Ixxxxiii,

Intermediate Example 91 - Compound lxxxxiv
Compound Ixxxxiii is hydrogenated using 10% Pd/C (1% mol) in methyl alcohol under hydrogen to afford 335 mg (100%) of compound lxxxxiv,

209


Intermediate Example 92 - Compound Ixxxxv
Ethyl lH-tetrazole-5-acetate (5 g, 32 mmol) is taken up in chloroform (80 mL). Trichloroacetic acid (12.03 g, 73.65 mniol) is added followed by alpha methyl styrene (3.78 g, 32 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred overnight. The next day, the solution is diluted with ethyl acetate, washed with 10% KOH and brine. The organic phase is dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to afford 8 g (96%) of the corresponding
N-protected ethyl tetrazole-5-acetate. This material is subjected to standard hydrolysis conditions using ethyl alcohol (0.3 M) and 1 N NaOH (3 eq) to afford 7 g (99%) of compound Ixxxxv,

Intermediate Example 93 - Compound lxxxxvi
Intermediate Example 94 - Compound lxxxxvii
Compound Ixxxxv (3.62 g, 14.7 mmol) is taken up in dichloromethane (50 mL). EDCI (4.32 g, 22.1 mmol) and D1PEA (5.1 mL, 29.4 mmol) are added and stirred for five minutes. N-hydroxy succinimide (3.38 g, 29.4 mmol) is added and stirred three hours. The reaction is diluted with dichloromethane and washed with water three times. The organic phase is dried ove: sodium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to afford 3.66 g (73%) of compound lxxxxvi,


210
Compound lxxxxiv (335 mg, 0.62 mmol) and compound Ixxxxvi (343 mg, 1 mmol) are taken up in dichloromethane (6 mL). D1PEA (0.17 mL, 1 mmol) is added and reaction mixture stirred overnight. The reaction is diluted with ethyl acetate, washed with saturated sodium bicarbonate, brine and concentrated. The residue is purified in 5% ethyl alcohol / ethyl acetate to give 80 mg (16%) of compound lxxxxvii,

Intermediate Example 95 - Compound lxxxxviii
Compound lxxxxvii (80 mg, O.llmmol) is taken up in dichloromethane (3 mL). DMP reagent reagent (55 mg, 0.13 mmol) is added and stirred for one hour. The reaction mixture is diluted with ethyl acetate and quenched with 10% solution of sodium sulfite. The organic phase is washed with saturated sodium bicarbonate and brine. The organic phase is concentrated and the reultine residue is purified in 100% ethvl acetate to afford 40 me (48%) of compound

Intermediate Example 96 - Compound xxxix
quantitative yield from compound c, N-Cbz-4-hydroxy Pro), is dissolved in DCM (25
Compound ic, N-Cbz-4-Hydroxy Pro methyl ester, (2.1 g, 7.9 mmol is prepared in



211
mL). CDI (1.54 g, 9.5 ramol) and DIPEA (1.7 mL, 9.5 mmol) are added to the solution and stirred for 10 minutes. 1,2,3,4-Tetrahydroisoquinoline (TIQ) (1.2 mL, 9.5 mmol) is added drop-wise to the reaction mixture and stirred five hours. The organic phase is washed with water, 1 N HC1, and brine. Following the concentration of thee organic phase, the resultant residue is chromatographically purified by 40% EtOAc/Hexanes to yield compound ci, N-Cbz-4-TIQcarbonyloxy-Pro methyl ester, (2.5 g, 75%).

Compound ci (2.5 g, 5.9 mmol) is dissolved in MeOH (75 mL). The solution is flushed withN2and Pd/C(10%, 300 mg) is added. The reaction mixture is flushed with H2 and stirred overnight. The reaction mixture is filtered through Celite and concentrated to yield compound compound xxxix, 4-(TIQ-carbonyloxy)-Pro, methyl ester,(1.49 g, 83%).
Intermediate Example 97 - Compound vii
Compound cii, N-pyrazin-2-ylearbonyl-Val-Val methyl ester, (10.9 g, 32.4 mmol) is

dissolved in THF (80 mL), and then aqueous NaOH (48.6 mL, 48.6 mmol) is added. The resulting mixture is stirred 48 hours, and then additional NaOH (16.3 mL, 16.3 mmol) is added and mixture is heated to 40°C for three hours. The pH of the reaction mixture is then lowered to 3, and the acqueous phase extracted with EtOAc and then concentrated to yield crude compound vii, N-pyrazin-2-ykarbonyl-Val-Val acid (10.6 g, 100%).

212
Intermediate Example 98 - Compound ciii
Compound cii (4.1 g, 12.7 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (20 mL). HOAt (1.73 g, 12.7 mmol) and DCC (12.7 mmol) are added to this solution, and the solution stirred for one hour. Compound xxxix (3.22 g, 10.6 mmol) is added to reaction mixture in DCM (10 mL). The resulting mixture is stirred overnight under N2 The reaction mixture is filtered through silica gel and concentrated. The resulting residue is purified by silica gel chromatography (50% to 80% EtOAc/Hexanes gradient) to yield compound ciii,
N-pyrazin-2-ylcarbonyl-Val-Val-4-(TIQcarbonyloxy)-Pro methyl ester, (5.27 g, 81,7%).

Intermediate Example 99 - Compound civ
Compound ciii (650 ing, 1.19 mmol) is dissolved in THF (5 mL). Aqueous NaOH (1.42 mL, 1.42 mmol) is added to the solution and then stirred overnight. The pH of the solution is lowered to 3, and the organic phase is isolated and concentrated to yield a residue. The residue is purifed using reverse phase HPLC in acetonitrile/water to yield compound civ, N-pyrazin-2-ylcarbonyl-Val-Val-4-(TIQcarbonyloxy)-Pro acid, (600 mg, 95%).

Intermediate Example 100 - Compound cv
N-Boc-L-tert-Leucine (2.3 g, 10 mmol) and L-tert-Leucine methyl ester hydrochloride (2 g, 11 mmol) are combined in DMF (30 mL). HOAt (1.6 g, 11.5 mmol) is then added to the
solution. The resulting mixture is stirred for 20 minutes under N2 and then lowered to 0°C
i'
whereupon DIC (1.8 mL, 11.5 mmol) and 2,4,6-collidine (1.45 mL, 11 mmol) are added. The resulting solution is stirred overnight with wanning to room temperature. The reaction mixture is

213
diluted with EtOAc, and the organic phase washed with 1 N HC1, saturated NaHCO3 and brine. Following the concentration of the organic phase, the resultant residue is chroniatographically purified by 20% - 30% EtOAc/hexanes gradient to yield compound cv (3.3 g, 92%).


214
Intermediate Example 101 - Compound cvi
Compound cv (3.3 g, 9.2 mmol) is hydrolyzed using dioxane (40 mL) and 0.5 N NaOH (37 mL, 18.4 mmol) to yield compound cvi (2.9 g, 92%).

Intermediate Example 102 - Compound cvii
Compound cvi (2 g, 5.8 mmol) and compound v (1 g, 5.5 mmol) are dissolved in DMF (20 mL). HOAt (832 mg, 6.6 mmol) and DIC (1.1 mL, 6.6 mmol) are then added to the solution. The resulting solution is stirred overnight under N2. The reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc, and the organic phase washed with 1 N HC1, saturated NaHCC>3 and brine. Following the concentration of the organic phase; the resultant residue is chromatographically purified by 20%-30% EtOAc/hexanes gradient to yield compound cvii (2.4 g, 81%).

Intermediate Example 103 - Compound cviiii
Intermediate Example 104 - Compound cix
2-Pyrazinecarboxylic acid (181 mg, 1.46 mmol) and compound cviii (541 mg, 1.325
Compound cvii (2.4 g, 4.72 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (10 mL). TFA (10 mL) is added to the solution. The resulting solution is stirred for 4 hours. The reaction mixture is concentrated, dissolved in EtOAc, and then the organic phase is washed with 1 N NaOH and brine. The organic phase is concentrated to yield compound cviii (1.084 g, 56.1%).


215
mmol) are dissolved in DMF (15 mL). HOAt (207 mg, 1.52 mmol) and DIG (0.24 mL, 1.52 mmol) are added to the solution. The resulting solution is stirred overnight under N2. The reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc, and the organic phase washed with 1 N HCI, saturated. NaHCO3 and brine. Following the concentration of the organic phase, the resultant residue is chromatographically purified by 20%-30%-35% EtOAc/hexanes gradient to yield compound cix (430 me, 63%).

Intermediate Example 105 - Compound ex
Compound cix is hydrolyzed using EtOH (7 mL) and 1 N NaOH (4.7 mL, 4.7 mmol) to yield compound ex (700 mg, 91.6%).

Intermediate Example 106 - Compound cxi
Compound ex (690 mg, 1.42 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (9 mL). PyBOP (890 mg, 1.7 mmol) is then added to the solution, followed by the addition of Compound xiii' (320

mg, 1.7 mmol). To the resulting mixture is added DIPEA (0.3 mL, 1.7 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred overnight under N2- The reaction mixture is then diluted with EtOAc, washed with saturated NaHCO3, and brine. Following the concentration of the organic phase, the resultant residue is chromatographically purified by 100% EtOAc to yield compound cxi (490 mg, 52.7%).


216
ntermediate Example 107 - Compound cxiv
Compound cxii (1.2 g, 3.06 mmol) is dissolved in MeOH (12 mL). After thoroughly

flushing with N2,10 wt% Pd(OH)2 on carbon (0.6 g) is added and the mixture is hydrogenated for overnight, whereupon a complete reaction mixture is shown by TLC (30% EtOAc/hexanes). The solution is isolated from solid material by fillration and concentrated to the corresponding deprotected compound cxiiias a colorless oil (100%)

that is used in the next step without further purification.
2-Pyrazinecarboxylic acid (400 mg, 3.2 mmol, 1.1 eq) is dissolved in DCM/THF (4 mL/4 ml.), and then HOAt (440 rag, 3.2 mmol) and DCC (343 mL, 1 M in DCM) are added. After stirring at room temperature for 20 minutes, the compound cxiii (0.96 g, 3.2 mmol) obtained previously is dissolved in DCM (6.4 mL) and added to the activated mixture. After stirring overnight at room temperature, the reaction mixture is filtered through Celite and compound cxiv is purified by column chrornatography (30% EtOAc/hexanes)

to yield a white solid (0.8 g, 80%).

217
Intermediate Example 108 - Compound cxv
Compound cxiv (0.8 g, 2.2 mmol) is dissolved in MeOH (10 mL), and then 2 N NaOH (aq) (3.3 mL, 6.6 mmol) is added. The solution is stirred at room temperature overnight, whereupon the completion of the reaction mixture is indicated by TLC (50% EtOAc/hexanes). Acidification to pH 3 by 5 N HCI and diluted with EtOAc is followed by extraction of the organic phase. The extracted organic phase is washed with brine and dried over MgSO4 to yield compound cxv (0.74, 95%) upon concentration.

Intermediate Example 109 - Compound cxvi
To a DCM solution (6 mL) of compound cxv (0.74 g, 2.1 mmol) at room temperature is added HOAt (290 mg, 2.1 mmol), followed by the addition of 1 M DCC solution in DCM (2.2 mL, 2.2 mmol). After stirring for 30 minutes at room temperature, a THF solution (10.5 mL, 0.2 M) of compound v (2.1 mmol) is added to liie above HOAt-activated acid. The reaction mixture is stirred at room temperature overnight. At this point, the reaction mixture is filtered through celite. The filtrate is diluted with EtOAc (120 mL) and washed with water and brine. The organic phase is dried and concentrated to a yellow oil that is purified by silica gel chromatography (50% EtOAc/hexanes) to yield compound cxvi (0.714 g, 66%).

Intermediate Example 110 - Compound cxvii
To an EtOH solution of compound cxvi (0.7 g, 1.4 mmol) is added 2 N NaOH aqueous solution (2 mL, 4 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred overnight at room temperature, then acidified to pH 3 by 5 N HCI and diluted with EtOAc is followed by extraction of the organic phase. The extracted organic phase is washed with brine and dried over MgSO4 to yield compound cxvii (95%) upon concentration.

218

Intermediate Example 111 -Compound cxviii
To a DCM/THF solution (10 mL/2 mL) of compound cvii (300 mg, 0.6 mmol) is added PyBOP (416 mg, 0.8 mmol). The solution is stirred at room temperature for 30 minutes. To this solution is then added compound xxxvi' (200 mg, 0.8 mmol), followed by DIPEA

(0.22 mL, 1.2 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred at room temperature overnight and then quenched with water (25 mL) for 30 minutes. The mixture is then extracted with EtOAc. The resulting organic phase is washed with brine and dried over MgSO*, before being concentrated to yield a yellow oil. Purification by silica gel chromatography (3-5% EtOH/EtOAc) yields compound cxviii (335 mg, 76%).

Intermediate Example 112 - Compound cxix
To a DCM solution (10 mL) of compound cxvii (340 mg, 0.6 mmol) is added PyBOP (470 mg, 0.9 mmol). The solution is stirred at room temperature for 30 minutes. To this solution is then added compound xiii' (170 mg, 0.9 mmol), followed by DIPEA (0.24 mL, 1.2 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred at room temperature overnight and then quenched with water (25 mL) for 30 minutes. The mixture is then extracted with EtOAc. The resulting organic phase is washed

219
with brine and dried over MgSO4, before being concentrated to yellow oil. Purification by silica gel chromatography (3-5% EtOH/EtOAc) yields compound cxix (164 mg, 36%).

Intermediate Example 113 - Compound xx
N-Cbz-L-Valine (6.28 g, 25 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (30 mL). HOBT (3.38 g, 25 mmol) and DCC (25 mL, 1 M solution) are added to this solution and stirred five minutes. L-tert-Leucine methyl ester hydrochloride (25 mL, 1 M solution) is added to this mixture and stirred overnight under N2- The reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc, washed with 1 N HC1, saturated NaHCO3, and brine. The organic phase is dried over NazSO*, filtered and concentrated. The residue is chromatographically purified by 20%-30% EtOAc/hexanes to yield compound xx (2.96g, 31%).
Intermediate Example 114 - Compound xxi
Compound xx (2.95 g, 7.8 mmol) is hydrogenated using 10% Pd/C (800 mg) in MeOH (40 mL) under H2 to yield the below corresponding free amine (1.9g, 100%).

2-Pyrazine-carboxylic acid (970 mg, 7.8 mmiol) is dissolved in DCM (20 mL). PyBOP (4.06 g, 7.8 mmol) is added to this solution. The free amine (1.9 g, 7.8 mmol) in DCM (15 mL) is added to the solution, and then DEPEA (1.36 mL, 7.8 mmol) is added. The resulting mixture is stirred overnight under N2- The reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc, and the organic phase is washed with saturated NaHC03 and brine. Following the concentration of the organic phase, the residue is chromatographically purified by 30%-40% EtOAc/Hexanes to yield compound xxi (2.07g, 75.8%).

220

Intermediate Example 115 - Compound xxii
Compound xxi is hydrolyzed using MeOH (20 mL) and 1 N NaOH (3 eq) to yield compound xxii (1.82e. 93.9%).

Intermediate Example 116 - Compound xxiii
Compound xxii (895 mg, 2.66 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (10 mL). DCC (3.2 mmol) is added to the solution, and then HOAt (435 mg, 3.2 mmol) is added. Compound v (3.2 mmol) in THF (16 mL) is then added. The resulting mixture is stirred overnight under N2. The reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc, filtered through silica gel, and concentrated. The resulting residue is chromatographically purified by 50% EtOAc/hexanes to yield compound xxiii (730 mg, 54.8%).
Intermediate Example 117 - Compound xxiv
Compound xxiii is hydrolyzed using EtOH (5 mL) and 1 N NaOH (1.5 eq) to yield compound
xxiv (690 mg, 100%).
Intermediate Example 118 - Compound cxx
Compound xxiv (245 mg, 0.52 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (3 mL). PyBOP (330 mg, 0.62 mmol) is added to the solution, and then compound xiu" (120 mg, 0.62 mmol) is added. To the resulting mixture is added DIPEA (0.11 mL, 0.62 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred overnight under N2. The reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc, and the organic phase washed

221
with saturated NaHCO3 and brine. Following the concentration of the organic phase, the residue is chromatographically purified by 5% EtOH/EtOAc to yield compound cxx C220 me. 60%).



Intermediate Example 119 - Compound xiii'
Boc-NVA-OH (24.96 g, 114.9 mmol) is dissolved in THF (200 mL). CDI (22.35,137.8

mmol) is added portion-wise to the solution, and the solution is stirred for 30 minutes. N,O-Dimethylhydroxylamine hydrochloride (12.33 g, 126.4 mmol) is dissolved in DMF (50 mL) and then DIPEA (22 mL, 126.4 mmol) is added to the solution. The DMF solution is allowed to stir at room temperature for 20 minutes and then added to THF solution. The resulting mixture is stirred over a weekend under N2. The reaction mixture is concentrated in vacuo to 100 mL total volume. This organic phase is washed with 1 N HC1, saturated NaHCO3 and brine. The organic phase is concentrated to yield crude compound cxxi (25.3 g).

LAH (107.3 mmol) is added to a dry 1-L round bottom flask under N2 in a lMEt2O solution. This solution is lowered to 0°C, and then compound cxxi (97.5 mmol) is added drop-wise in Et2O (100 mL). Upon completion of the addition, the resulting mixture is stirred for 30 minutes. The reaction mixture is quenched at 0°C by slowly adding EtOAc (50 mL), followed by slowly adding a 5% KHSO4 (50 mL) solution. This mixture is stirred for 30 minutes. The

222
organic phase is washed with 1 N HC1, saturated NaHCO3, and brine. The organic phase is concentrated to yield crude compound cxxii (22.28 g).

Compound cxxii is dissolved in MeOH (100 mL). Na2S2O4 (16.82 g, 96.6 mmol) is dissolved in water (100 mL and then added to solution of compound cxxii at 0°C. This mixture is stored in the refrigerator (5°C) overnight. KCN (7.53 g, 115.9 mmol) in water (100 mL) is added to reaction mixture and stirred for 1.5 hours at room temperature. The compound is extracted with EtOAc (3x100 mL). The organic phase is washed with brine (3x50 mL), dried over MgSO4, filtered and concentrated to yield crude compound cxxiii (15.86g).

Compound cxxiii (15.86 g) is dissolved in dioxane (100 mL). Concentrated HC1 (37%, 100 mL) is added to this solution followed by anisole (10 mL) and reflux is established (110°C). The reaction stirred for 1.5 hours. - When the reaction mixture is cooled to room temperature, the solvent is removed in vacua to yield a dry paste. The residue is dried overnight under high vacuum to yield crude compound cxxiv.

Compound cxxiv (69.6 mmol) is dissolved in DMF (60 mL) and THF (60 mL). N-(Benzyl-oxycarbonyloxy)succinimide (17.33 g, 69.6 mmol) is added to the mixture, followed by the addition of DIPEA (12.1 mL, 69.6 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred overnight under N2. The mixture is concentrated to a reduced volume (50 mL) and diluted with EtOAc. The organic

223
phase is washed with 0.1 N HC1 (2x100 mL) and brine to yield compound cxxv (17.5 g, 54.2% over five steps).

Compound cxxv (5.66 g, 20.14 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (60 mL). PyBOP (12.57 g, 24.2 mmol) and HOBT (3.27 g, 24.2 mmol) are added to this solution and stirred five minutes. The resulting mixture is lowered to 0°C, and then cyclopropylamine (1.67 mL, 24.2 mmol) and DIPEA (4.2 mL, 24.2 mmol) are added. The reaction mixture is stirred overnight warming to room temperature. The reaction mixture is washed with 0.1 N HC1, saturated NaHCO3, and brine. The organic phase is then concentrated and chromatographically purified using 70% EtOAc/Hexanes to yield compound cxxvi (3.18 g, 49.3%).

Compound cxxvi (3.18 g, 9.94 mmol) is hydrogenated using 10% Pd/C (600 mg) in MeOH (70 mL). The reaction mixture is stirred overnight under H2, filtered through celite and concentrated to yield crude compound xiii' (2.1 g, 100%).

Intermediate Example 120 - Compound cxxvii
N-Cbz-L-Cyclohexylglycine (3 g, 10.3 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (36 mL). HOAt (1.5 g, 11.28 mmol) and DCC (11.28 mL, 11.28 mmol) are added to this solution and stirred five minutes. L-tert-Leucine methyl ester hydrochloride (103 mL, 1 M solution, 10.3 mmol) is added to this mixture and stirred overnight under N2- The reaction mixture is filtered through celite,

224
rinsed with EtOAc and concentrated to a residue that is purified chromatographically using 20%-30% EtOAc/hexanes to yield compound cxxvii (2.2 g, 52%).

Intermediate Example 121 - Compound Ixxix'
Compound cxxvii (2.2 g, 5.2 mmol) is hydrogenated using 20% Pd(OH)2/C (1 g) in MeOH (15 mL) under H2 to yield compound Ixxix' (1.4 g, 98%).

Intermediate Example 122 - Compound Ixxx
2-Pyrazinecarboxylic acid (360 mg, 2.9 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (10 mL). PyBOP (3.81 g, 3.5 mmol) is added to the solution. Compound Ixxix' (825 mg, 2.9 mmol) in THF (10 mL) is then added to the solution, followed by the addition of DIPEA (0.5 mL, 2.9 mmol). The resulting mixture is stirred overnight under N2. The reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc, and the organic phase washed with saturated NaHCO3 and brine. The residue resulting from the concentration of the organic phase is chromatographicaUy purified by 30% EtOAc/Hexanes to yield Compound Ixxx (780 mg, 69%).
Intermediate Example 123 - Compound lxxxi
Compound Ixxx is hydrolyzed using MeOH (10 mL) and 1 N NaOH (3 eq) to yield compound Ixxxi (615 mg, 81.8%).
Intermediate Example 124 - Compound lxxxii
Compound Ixxxi (610 mg, 1.6 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (10 mL). DCC (1.94 mL, 1.94 mmol) is then added to the solution, followed by the addition of HOAt (270 mg, 1.94 mmol). Compound v (1.94 mmol) in THF (19.4 mL) is then added to the solution. The resulting mixture

225
is stirred over two nights under N3. The reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc, filtered through silica gel, and concentrated. The resulting residue is purified chromatographically by 40% EtOAc/hexanes to yield compound Ixxxii (450 mg, 83.4%).
Intermediate Example 125 - Compound lxxxiii
Compound lxxxi is hydrolyzed using EtOH (10 mL) and 1 N NaOH (3 eq) to yield compound lxxxiii (650 mg, 99%).
Intermediate Example 126 - Compound cxxviii
Compound lxxxiii (400 mg, 0.78 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (5 mL). PyBOP (610 mg, 1.2 mmol) is added to the solution, followed by Compound xiii' (230 mg, 1.2 mmol). To the resulting mixture is added DIPEA (0.2 mL, 1.2 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred overnight under N2. The reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc, and the organic phase washed with saturated NaHCC>3 and brine. Following the concentration of the organic phase, the residue is chromatographically purified by 100% EtOAc to 5% EtOH/EtOAc gradient to yield compound cxxviii (365 mg, 68.7%).

Intermediate Example 127 - Compound cxxx
Compound lxxxiii (365 mg, 0.7 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (5 roL). PyBOP (440 mg, 0.84 mmol) is added to the solution, followed by the addition of compound cxxix (0.84

mmol) in THF (8.4 mL). To the resulting mixture is added DIPEA (0.1 mL, 0.84 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred overnight under N2. The reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc, and

226
the organic phase is washed with satutrated NaHCO3 and brine. Following the concentration of the organic phase, the resulting residue is chromatographically purified by 100% EtOAc to yield compound cxxx (350 mg, 70%).

Intermediate Example 128 - Compound cxxxi
Compound cxxv (2.54 g, 9.05 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (30 mL). PyBOP (5.65 g, 10.9 mmol) and HOBT (1.47 g, 10.9 mmol) are added to the solution and stirred five minutes. The resulting mixture is lowered to 0°C, whereupon (S)-(+)-3-MethyI-2-butylamine (1.27 mL, 10.9 mmol) and DIPEA (1.9 raL, 10.9 mmol) are added. The reaction mixture is stirred overnight with warming to room temperature. The organic phase is washed with 0.1 N HC1, saturated NaHCO3 and brine. Following the concentration of the organic phase, the resultant residue is chromatographically purified by 30% EtOAc/hexanes to yield compound cxxxi (1.44 g, 45.5%).

Intermediate Example 129 - Compound cxxix
Compound cxxxi (1.3 g, 3.7 mmol) is hydrogenated using 10% Pd/C (500 mg) in MeOH (40 mL). The reaction mixture is stirred overnight under H2. The reaction mixture is filtered through celite and the organic phase concentrated to yield crude compound cxxix (800 mg, 100%).

227

Intermediate Example 130 - Compound cxxxiv
Compound cxxxii (1.6 g, 3.7 mraol) is dissolved in MeOH (12 mL). After thoroughly

flushing with N2, 10 wt% Pd(OH)2 on carbon (0.74 g) is added and the mixture is hydrogenated overnight, whereupon a complete reaction mixture is shown by TLC (30% EtOAc/hexanes). The solution is isolated from solid material by filtration and concentrated to yield compound cxxxiii as colorless oil (100%) that is used in the: next

step without further purification. 2-Pyrazinecarboxylic acid (400 mg, 3.2 mmol, 1.1 eq) is dissolved in DCM/THF (4mL/4 mL), and then HOAt (440 mg, 3.2 mmol) and DCC (3.3 mL, 1 M in DCM) is added. After stirring at room temperature for 20 minutes, compound cxxxiii (0.96 g, 3.2 mmol) obtained previously is dissolved in DCM (6.4 mL) and added to the activated mixture. After stirring over 2 days at room temperature, the reaction mixture is filtered through Celite, and concentrated to a residue that is purified by column chromatography (50% EtOAc/hexanes) to yield compound cxxxiv as a white solid (1.06 g, 83%).

228

Intermediate Example 131 - Compound cxxxv
Compound cxxxiv (1.06 g, 2.6 mmol) is dissolved in MeOH (10 mL), and then 2 N NaOH (aq) (4 mL, 8 mmol) is added. The solution is stirred at room temperature overnight, whereupon the completion of the hydrolysis is indicated by TLC (50% EtOAc/hexanes). The solution is acidified to pH 3 by 5 N HCI, diluted with EtOAc and then the organic phase is extracted. The extracted organic phase is washed with brine and dried over MgSC>4 to yield compound cxxxv (100%) upon concentration.

Intermediate Example 132 - Compound cxxxvi
To a DCM solution (8 mL) of compound cxxxv (1.44 g, 3 -7 mmol) at room temperature is added HOAt (500 mg, 3.7 mmol), and then 1 M DCC solution in DCM (3.7 mL, 3.7 mmol) is added. After stirring for 30 minutes at room temperature, a THF solution (18.5 mL, 0.2 M ) of compound v (3.7 mmol) is added to the above HOAt-activated acid. The reaction mixture is stirred at room temperature overnight. The reaction mixture is Filtered through Celite. The filtrates are diluted with EtOAc (120 mL) and washed with water and brine. The organic phase is dried and concentrated to yield yellow oil that is purified by silica gel chromatography (70% EtOAc/hexanes) to yield compound cxxxvi (1 g, 71%).


229
Intermediate Example 133 - Compound cxxxvii
To an BOH solution (8 mL) of compound cxxxvi (1 g, Lg mmol) is added 2 N NaOH aqueous solution (2.7 mL, 5.4 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred overnight at room temperature, then acidified to PH 3 by 5 N HO, diluted with EtOAc, and then the organic phase is extracted. The extracted organic phase is washed with brine and dried over MgSO4 to yield compound cxxxvii (88%) upon concentration.

Intermediate Example 133 - Compound cxxxviii
To a DCM solution (10 mL) of compound cxxxvii (350 mg, 0.6 mmol) is added PyBOP (450 mg, 0.86 mmol). The solution is stirred at room temperature for 30 minutes. To this solution is then added compound xiii' (160 mg, 0.86 mmol) followed by DJPEA (0.23 mL, 1.3 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred at room temperature overnight and then quenched with water (25 mL) for 30 minutes. The mixture is then extracted with EtOAc. The extracted organic phase is washed with brine and dried over MgSO4, before being concentrated to yield yellow oil. Purification by silica gel chromatography (5% EtOH/EtOAc) yields compound cxxxviii (407 mg, 88%).

Intermediate Example 134 - Compound cxxxix
5-Methylisoxazole-3-carboxylic acid (200 mg, 2.05 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (5 mL). pyBOP (1.07 g, 2.05 mmol) is added to the solution. Compound lxxix' (582 mg, 2.05 mmol) in DCM (5 rnL) is added to the solution, followed by the addition of DIPEA (0.36 mL, 2.05 mmol). The resulting mixture is stirred overnight under N2. The reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc, and the organic phase washed with saturated NaHCO3 and brine. The organic phase is

230
concentrated, and the resultant residue is purified chroiuato-graphically by 30% EtOAc/hexanes to yield Compound cxxxix (495 mg, 61.4%).

Intermediate Example 135 - Compound cxxxx
Compound cxxxix is hydrolyzed using MeOH (10 mL) and 1 N NaOH (3 eq) to yield compound cxxxx (430 mg, 90%).

Intermediate Example 136 - Compound cxxxxi
Compound cxxxx (380 mg, 1 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (5 mL). DCC (1.2 mmol) is then added to the solution, followed by the addition of HO At (165 mg, 1.2 mmol). Compound v (1-2 mmol) is then added in THF (12 mL). The resulting mixture is stirred overnight under N2. The reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc, filtered through silica gel, and concentrated. The resultant residue is chromatographically purified by 35% EtOAc/hexanes to yield compound cxxxxi (320 mg, 58%).

Intermediate Example 137 - Compound cxxxxii
Compound cxxxxi is hydrolyzed using EtOH (10 mL) and 1 N NaOH (3 eq) to yield compound cxxxxii (730 mg, 943%).

231
i
Intermediate Example 138 - Compound cxxxxiii
Compound cxxxxii (240 mg, 0.46 mmol) is dissolved in PCM (5 mL). PyBOP (295 mg, 0.56 mmiol) is then added to the solution, followed by the addition of Compound xiii' (110 mg, 0.56 mmol)- To the resulting mixture is added DIPEA (0.1 mL, 0.56 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred over two nights under N2. The reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc, and the organic phase washed with saturated NaHCO3 and brine. Following the concentration of the organic phase, the resultant residue is chromatographically purified by 90% EtOAc/hexanes to yield Compound cxxxxiii (168 mg, 53%).

Intermediate Example 139 - Compound cxxxxiv
To a solution of NaOH (2N, 42.1 mL, 84.2 mmol) at 5 °C is added L-alanine (5.00 g, 56.1 mmol). After stirring for 10 minutes, methyl chloroformate (6.5 mL, 84.2 mmol) and NaOH (2 N, 42.1 mL, 84.2 mmol) are added dropwise simultaneously. The solution is stirred in ice bath for 2 hours, then at room temperature for 1 hour. The mixture is washed with Et2O (2 x 50 mL), the aqueous layer is neutralized to pH ~2 with 5 N HC1, and extracted with EtOAc (3 x 50 mL).
The extracted organic phase is washed with brine, dried by MgSO4 and concentrated to yield
rcompound cxxxxiv,
N-carbomethoxy-L-alanine, (4.54 g, 54%) as colorless oil.

232
Intermediate Example 140 - Compound cxxxxvi
A solution of compound cxxxxv (3.57 g, 9.44 mmol) in THF at 5 °C is treated with HOAt

(1.28 g, 9.44 mmol), and then DCC (9.50 mL, 9.50 mmol) is added. After stirring in ice bath for 45 minutes, a solution of compound v (104 mL, 10.4 mmol) in THF is added. The mixture is stirred at room temperature overnight. The mixture is cooled to 5 °C and quenched with saturated NaHCO3. After filtration to remove the precipitated DCU, the mixture is dissolved in EtOAc (100 mL), washed with saturated NaHCO3, brine, and then dried by MgSO4 and concentrated to a residue purified by silica column chro:matography (25% EtOAc/Hexanes) to yield compound cxxxxvi (2.91 g, 57%) as gummy foam.

Intermediate Example 141 - Compound cviii
To a solution of compound cxxxxvi in MeOH (25 mL) cooled by an ice bath under a stream of N2 is added slowly Pd/C. The mixture is hydrogenated at 1 arm overnight. The catalyst is removed by filtration, the filtrate is combined with 5 mL DMF and dried under vacuum to yield compound cviii.
Intermediate Example 142 - Compound cxxxxvii
To a solution of compound cxxxxiv (0.298 g, 2.03 mmol) and HOAt (0.276 g, 2.03 mmol) in THF cooled in ice bath is treated with DCC (2.05 mL, 2.05 mmol). After stirring in an ice bath for 0.5 hour, a solution of compound cviii in THF is added, and then DIPEA (0.39 mL, 2.2 mmol) is added. The mixture is stirred at room temperature overnight, then cooled in an ice bath, and quenched with saturated NaHCO3. The precipitated DCU is filtered and the filtrate is

233
dissolved in EtOAc (100 mL). The organic phase is washed with saturated NaHC03, brine, and then dried by MgSO4. After removal of the organic solvent, the residue is.purified by silica column chromatography (60% EtOAc/Hexanes) to yield compound cxxxxvii (0.47 g, 48%) as gummy foam.

Intermediate Example 143 - Compound cxxxxviii
To a solution of compound cxsxxvii (0.47 g, 0.847 mmol) in EtOH (5 mL) at 5 °C is added NaOH (2 N, 1.31 mL, 2.62 mmol). The mixture is stirred at room temperature for 4 hours. The solution is acidified to pH ~2 with HC1 (IN) and the EtOH is removed by rotary evaporation. The mixture is extracted with EtOAc (3x30 mL) and the combined extract is washed with brine, and then dried by MgSO4. The solvent is removed and the residue is dried under vacuum to yield compound cxxxxviii (0.366 g, 82%) as gummy foam.
Intermediate Example 144 - Compound cil
A solution of compound cxxxxviii (0.366 g, 0.718 mmol) in DCM is cooled in an ice bath and treated with PyBop (0.599 g, 1.15 mmol). After stirring at room temperature for 0.5 hour, the mixture is cooled by an ice bath and treated with a solution of compound xiii' (0.200 g, 1.08 mmol) in THF and DJPEA (0.250 mL, 1.44 mmol). The mixture is stirred at room temperature overnight and then quenched with NH4CI solution. The solvent is concentrated and the mixture is dissolved in EtOAc (100 mL). The organic phase is washed with saturated NaHCO3, brine, and then dried by MgSO4. After removal of the organic solvent, the residue is purified by column chromatography (5% EtOH/EtOAc) to yield compound cil (0.35 g, 72%)

234

Intermediate Example 145 - Compound cxxi
To a THF solution (85 mL) of N-Boc-Nva-OH (compound 1) (8.68 g, 40 mmol) is added CDI (7.79 g, 48 mmol). After stirring at room temperature for 30 minutes, the above solution is treated with a DMF solution (25 mL) containing N,Oniimethyl-hydroxylamine hydrochloride (4.25 g, 44 mmol) and DIPEA (7.66 mL, 44 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred overnight at room temperature. The reaction mixture is then concentrated in vacuo. The resulting residue is diluted with EtOAc (300 mL). This solution is washed sequentially with 0.1 N HC1 (50 mL), saturated NaHCO3 (3 x 50 mL) arid brine. The organic phase is concentrated in vacuo to yield a residue that is purified with silica gel chromatography (40% EtOAc/Hexanes) to compound cxxi (9.38 g, 94%).
Intermediate Example 146 - Compound cxxii
To a diethyl Et2O solution (50 mL) of compound cxxi (9.38 g, 31.9 mmol) cooled to 0°C is added (slowly) LAH (34.7 mL, 1 M, 34.7 mmol). The temperature of the reaction flask is maintained below 5 °C during LAH addition. Upon completion of the addition, EtOAc (20 mL) is added to the reaction to quench the excess LAH. Aqueous KHSO4 (5%, 20 mL) is then added in a dropwise fashion in order to keep the temperature below 5 °C The organic phase is separated and then washed sequentially with 1 N HC1 (3 x 30 mL), saturated NaHCO3 (3 x 30 mL) and brine. The organic phase is concentrated and dried in vacuo to yield crude compound cxxii (5.18 g, 69%).
Intermediate Example 147 - Compound cl
To a THF (25 mL) suspension of Zn (2.75 g, 42 mraol) is added at reflux 0.2 mL of EtOC(O)CF2Br. This is followed by slowly adding a THF solution (25 mL) of compound cxxii (3.05 g, 15.0 mmol) and EtOC(O)CF2B]r (4.84 mL, 37.5 mmol). Upon completion of the addition of both reagents, the reaction mixture is further reftuxed for 30 minutes. The reaction mixture is

235
cooled to room temperature and diluted with DCM (200 mL). The organic phase is washed with 1 N KHSO4. The organic phase is concentrated and dried in vacuo to yield a residue that is purified by silica gel chromatography (20% EtOAc/Hexane) to yield compound cl (2.78 g, 57%).
This preparation is essentially the same as that disclosed by Thaisrivongs et al., J. Med. Chem.. 29, 2080-2087 (1986).
Intermediate Example 148 - Compound cli
A THF solution (40 mL) of compound cl (2.78 g, 8.53 mmol) is treated with 1 N NaOH (12.8 mL, 12.8 mmol). After stirring at room temperature overnight, the solvent is partially removed in vacuo. The remaining reaction mixture is diluted with water (50 mL) and lyophilized to yield crude compound cli (2.82 g, >100%) as its sodium salt.

This preparation is essentially the same as that disclosed by Thaisrivongs et al., J. Med. Chem.. 29,2080-2087(1986).
Intermediate Example 149 - Compound clii
A DCM solution (10 mL) of the crude compound cli (516 mg, 1.61 mmol) is treated with HOBT (436 mg, 3.23 mmol) aud DIG (0.328 mL, 2.09 mmol). After stirring at room temperature for 30 minutes, the reaction mixture is treated with a DCM solution (5 mL) containing glycine benzylester-TsOH salt (815 mg, 2.42 mmol) and DIPEA (0.422 mL, 2.42 mmol). After stirring at room temperature for 12 hours, the reaction mixture is quenched with water and extracted with EtOAc. The organic phase is dried and concentrated in vacuo and purified by silica gel chromatography (40% EtOAc/hexanes) to yield compound clii (495 mg, 69%).

236
1H NMR of compound clii (400 MHz, CDa3): 8 7.29-7.21 (m, 5H), 5.16 (bs, 2H), 4.89 (bs, 1H), 4.20-3.90 (m, 4H), 3.80 (bs, 1H), 1.75-1.42 (m, 4H), 1.38 (s, 9H), 0.87 (m, 3H).

Starting from crude compound cli, compounds cliii (83%) and cliv (50%) are prepared in an identical method to that described for compound clii.
]H NMR of compound cliii (400 MHz, CDC13): 5 7.49 (bs, 1H), 7.34-7.24 (ra, 5H), 5.13 (AB q, J = 12.2 Hz, J' = 23.9 Hz, 2H), 4.88 (bd, J = 8.8 Hz, 1H), 4.53 (m, 1H), 3.98-3.91 (m, 2H), 3.82 (m, 1H), 1.65-1.20 [in, 16H, including singlet at 1.37 (9H)], 0.86 (t, J = 7.3 Hz, 3H).

1H NMR of compound cliv (400 MHz, CDCh): 6 7.60-7.0 (m, 10H), 5.30-5.00 (m, 2H), 5.00-4.75 (m, 2H), 4.15-3.70 (m, 3H), 3.30-3.00 (m, 2H), 1.75-1.20 [m, 13H, including singlet at 1.36 (9H)], 0.86 (bs, 3H).

Intermediate Example 150 ~ Compound clv
To a DCM (10 mL) and THF (5 mL) solution of the crude compound cli (1 g, 3.13 ramol) is added HOBT (634 mg, 4.69 nunol) and EDCI (781 ing, 4.07 mmol), and then (s)-a-methylbenzylamine (0.604 mL, 4.69 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred overnight at room temperature and then quenched with water. The reaction mixture is extracted with EtOAc. The organic phase is washed with brine and dried by Na2SO4. The organic phase is concentrated in vacuo to yield a residue that is purified by silica gel chromatography (20% EtOAc/hexanes) to

237
yield compound clv (459 mg, 37%). 1H NMR of compound clv(400 MHz, CDCI3): 5 7.32-7.21 Cm, 6H), 5.00 (m, 1H), 4.75 (m, 1H), 3.94 (m, 2H), 3.70 (m, 1H), 1.65-1.15 [m, 16H, including doublet at 1.51 (J=6.8 Hz, 3H), singlet at 1.39 (9H)], 0.82 (m, 3H).

Intermediate Example 151 - Compound clvi
Compound clv (220 rag, 0.55 mmol) is dissolved in 4 N HC1 in dioxane (10 mL). The reaction mixture is stirred at room temperature for 2 hours and then concentrated in vacuo to give the crude compound clvi (-100%) as its HC1 salt.

Following the procedure described for preparing compound clvi, compounds clvii, clviii, and clix are prepared in almost quantitative yield from the crude compound cli.


238

Intermediate Example 152 - Compound clx
A DCM solution (4 mL) of the HC1 salt of compound vii (96 mg, 0.144 mmol) is treated with PyBOP (120 mg, 0.23 mmol) and DIPEA (0.1 mL, 0.576 mmol). After stirring at room temperature for 30 minutes, the solution is treated with a THF solution (4 mL) containing compound civ (0.288 mmol) and DIPEA (0.2 mL, 1.152 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred at room temperature overnight. The reaction mixture is then diluted with EtOAc (50 mL), and the organic phase then washed with NaHCO3 and brine. The organic phase is concentrated in vacuo and the residue purified by silica gel chromatography (80% EtOAc/hexanes) to yield compound clx (113 mg, 89%).

Intermediate Example 153 - Compound clxi
A DCM solution (6 mL) of compound vii (140 mg, 0.235 mmol) is treated with PyBOP (196 mg, 0.376 mmol) for 30 minutes. A THF solution (6 mL) of compound clvii (-0.47 mmol) and DIPEA (0.327 mL, 1.88 mmol) is then added to the above solution. The reaction mixture is stirred at room temperature overnight and quenched with water (30 minutes). The reaction mixture is extracted with EtOAc (50 mL). The organic phase is washed with NaHCO3 and brine. The combined aqueous layers are back extracted with EtOAc (50 mL). The combined organic phases are dried and concentrated in vacuo. The resultant residue is purified by silica gel chromatography (80-100 EtOAc/hexanes) to yield compound clxi (104 mg, 48%).

239

Intermediate Example 154 - Compound clxii
To a DCM solution (10 mL) of compound clxi (280 mg, 0.304 mmol) is added DMP reagent reagent (193 mg, 0.456 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred at room temperature for 3 hours and quenched with 10% Na2SO3. The organic phase is washed with NaHCO3 and brine. The resulting organic phase is dried and concentrated in vacuo to yield a residue that is purified with silica gel chromatography (80-100% EtOAcrtiexanes) to yield compound clxii (271 mg, 97%).
Intermediate Example 155 - Compound clxiii
Compound lxxxiii (220 mg, 0.43 mmol) is taken up in DCM (5 mL). PyBOP (270 mg, 0.51 mmol) is added to the DCM solution and stirred 5 minutes. Compound xxxvi' (0.51 mmol) in THF (5.1 mL) is added drop-wise to this solution. DIPEA (0.09 mL, 0.51 mmol) is added to reaction mixture and stirred overnight under N2- The next day, the reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc, washed with saturated NaHCO3, washed with brine. Purification by 70% to 90% EtOAc/Hexane gradient yields compound clxiii (180 mg, 56%).

240

Intermediate Example 156 - Compound clxiv
Compound cxxv (2.09 g, 7.4 mmol) is taken up in DCM (20 mL). PyBOP (4.64 g, 8.9 mmol) and HOBt (1.2 g, 8.9 mmol) are added to this solution and stirred five minutes. The resulting mixture is lowered to 0 C where S(-)-a-Methylbenzylamine (1.15 mL, 8.9 mmol) and DIPEA (1.55 mL, 8.9 mmol) are added. The reaction is stirred overnight with warming to room temperature. The reaction mixture is washed with 0.1 N HCI, sat NaHCO3, and brine. Purification by 30% EtOAc/Hexanes yields compound clxiv (1.6 g, 56.3%).

cixiv
Intermediate Example 157 - Compound xxxvi'
Compound clxiv (1.48 g, 3.8 mmol) is hydrogenated using 10% Pd/C (300 mg) in MeOH (50 mL). The reaction mixture stirred overnight under H2. The reaction mixture is filtered through celite and concentrated to give compound xxxvi' (895 mg, 94.2%).
Intermediate Example 158 - Compound clxvi:
To a DCM solution (15 mL) of compound clxv (2 g, 8.2 mmol) is added HOAt (1.34 g,


241
9.84 mmol) and DCC (9.S4 mL, 1 M, 9.S4 mniol). After stirring at room temperature for 20 minutes, a THF solution (9.84 mL) containing tert-L-Leucine methyl ester-hydrochloride (9.84 ramol) and DIPEA (1.72 mL, 9.84 mmol) is added to the above solution. Then DMAP (1 g, 8.2 mmol) is added at room temperature. The reaction is stirred at room temperature overnight. Following standard aqueous work-up and silica gel chromatography (20% EtOAc/Hexanes), compound clxvi (1.75 g, 58%) is obtained.

Intermediate Example 159 - Compound clxvii:
To a THF solution (35 mL) of compound clxvi (1.75 g, 4.73 ramol) is added 4 N HC1 solution in dioxane (11.8 mL, 47.3 mmol). The reaction is stirred at room temperature overnight. At this point, the solvent is removed under reduced pressure to yield crude clxvii (-100%), which is redissolved in DMF and used directly in the next reaction.

Intermediate Example 160 - Compound clxviii:
To a DCM solution (15 mL) containing 2-pyrazinecarboxylic acid (447 mg, 3.6 mmol), PyBOP (1.87 g, 3.6 mmol) is added a DMF solution (15 mL) of compound clxvii (811 mg, 3 mmol). To the resulting mixture is men added DIPEA (0.63 mL, 3.6 mmol). The reaction is stirred overnight at room temperature and then quenched with water. The reaction mixture is extracted with EtOAc. The organic layer is washed with brine and concentrated in vacuo to provide a residue that is purified by silica gel chromatography (40% EtOAc/Hexanes) to yield compound clxviii (0.93 g, 82%).

242

Intermediate Example 161 - Compound clxix:
To a MeOH solution (10 mL) of compound clxviii (0.93 g, 2.47 mmol) is added 2 N NaOH (3.71 mL, 7.41 mmol). The reaction is stirred at room temperature overnight. Then the reaction is acidified to pH 3 using 1 N HC1. The reaction is diluted with EtOAc (75 mL), and washed with water and brine. The organic layer thus obtained is dried and concentrated in vacuo to give compound clxix (-'100%).

Intermediate Example 162 - Compound clxx:
A DCM solution (10 mL) of compound clxix (2.47 mmol) is treated with HOAt (436 mg, 3.21 mmol) and DCC (3.2 mL, 1 M, 3.2 mmol). After stirring for 30 minutes, the reaction mixture is treated with a THF solution (13.6 mL) of compound v (499 mg, 2.72 mmol). After stirring at room temperature overnight, white solids (urea) are filtered. The filtrates are concentrated in vacuo to give a residue that is purified by silica gel chromatography to yield compound clxx (0.99 g, 76%).

Intermediate Example 163 - Compound clxxi:
An EtOH solution (20 mL) of compound clxx (0.99 g, 1.88 mmol) is treated with 2 N NaOH (2.81 mL, 5.63 mmol). After stirring at room temperature overnight, the reaction mixture




clxxiii

244
mmol) in THF (13 mL) is added drop-wise to this solution. DIPEA (0.23 mL, 1.3 mmol) is added to reaction mixture and allowed to warm to ambient temperature with stirring for two nights.. The next day, the reaction is concentrated and purified by 2% EtOH/EtOAc to give crude compound clxxiv (900 mg, excess of 100%).

Intermediate Example 166 - Compound clxxxv:
Compound cxxv (3.01 g, 10.7 mmol) is taken up in DCM (30 mL) and the temperature lowered to -78°C. PyBOP(6.1g, 11.7 mmol) and HOBT (1.58 g, 11.7 mmol) are added to this solution followed by (S)-(+)-l-cyclohexy]tethylamme, compound clxxv, (1.74 mL, 11.7 mmol) and DIPEA (2.1 mL, 11.7 mmol). The resulting mixture stirred overnight at room temperature. The next day, the reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc, washed with
0.1 N HC1, saturated NaHCO3, and brine. The product is purified in 40% EtOAc/Hex to give 2 g (47.8%) of compound clxv";

Intermediate Example 167 - Compound clxxiii:
Compound clxxvi (2 g, 5.13 mmol) is hydrogenated using 10% Pd/C (500 mg) in MeOH (40 mL). The reaction mixture stirred overnight under H2. The reaction mixture is filtered through celite and concentrated to give compound clxxiii (1.31 g, 99.8%).
Intermediate Example 168 - Compound clxxix:

245 In a round bottom flask under inert atmosphere, compound clxxvii [(S)-(-)-2-oxo 1,5

clxxvii
imidazoline dicarboxylic acid 1-benzyl ester] (290 ing, 1.1 mmol) is dissolved in anhydrous DMF (6 mL). HOAt (151 mg, 1.2 mmol) is added and the reaction is stiired at room temperature for 25 minutes. The reaction is then cooled down in an ice bath . DIC (0.2 mL, 0.16 g, 1.2 mmol) is then added followed by the addition of compound clxxvtii (1 mmol, 435 mg.) in anhydrous DMF (4 mL). The reaction is allowed to rise slowly to room temperature and stirred for 2 days. The reaction is then dumped in a separatory funnel containing 120 mL of EtOAc and washed 2X with 1 N HC1 (50 niL) and IX brine. The organic layer is separated, dried over MgSCV The solvent evaporated under reduced pressure and the residue purified by chromatography on silica gel (load in DCM and elute with 30% then 50% EtOAc/DCM then 2% MeOH/EtOAc) to yield product clxxix (434 mg, 64%).

Intermediate Example 169 - Compound clxxx:
The starting material clxxix (434 mg, 0.64 mmol) is dissolved in Dioxane (6 mL ) and 0.5 M aqueous NaOH solution (4 mL, 3 eq.)- The reaction is run overnight. TLC in 100% EtOAc (using PMA stain) shows in addition to the expected acid product at the origin, a faster running

246
product. The reaction mixture is acidified to pH 2 with 1 N HC1, and then extracted 2X with EtOAc. Solid NaCl is added to the aqueous solution to facilitate the extraction. The organic extracts are then combined, dried over MgSO4 and evaporated under reduced pressure. MS indicates that the CBZ group is removed by the hydrolysis. The resulting compund clxxx (quantitative yield) is used as is in the next step.

Intermediate Example 170 - Compound clxxxi:
In a round bottom flask under inert atmosphere, compound clxxx (279 mg, 0.54 mmol) is dissolved in anhydrous DMF (6 mL). HOAt (82 mg, 0.65 mmol) is added and the reaction is stirred at room temperature for 25 minutes. The reaction is then cooled down in an ice bath. DIC (0.11 mL, 0.65 mmol) is then added, followed by the addition of compound xiii' (0.7mmol)in anhydrous DMF (4 mL). The reaction is allowed to rise slowly to room temperature and stirred for 21 hours. The reaction is then dumped in a separatory funnel containing 120 mL of EtOAc and washed 2X with 1 N HC1 (50 mL) and IX brine. The organic layer is separated, dried over MgSO4. The solvent evaporated by reduced pressure and the product cleaned by chromatography on silica gel (load in DCM and elute with 50% EtOAc/Hexane, then 3% MeOH/EtOAc, then 20% EtOH/EtOAc). After removal of solvent, the residue is redissolved in Dri Solv THF and filtered to remove any silica gel. Removal of the solvent then yields compound clxxxi (434 mg, 64% yield).

247
Intermediate Example 171 - Compound clxxxiii:
In a round bottom flask under inert atmosphere, 6-hydroxy picolinic

(153 ing, 1.1 nunol) is dissolved in anhydrous DMF (6 mL). HOAt (151 mg, 1.2 mmol) is added and then thereaction is stirred at room temperature for 25 minutes. The reaction is then cooled down in an ice bath. DIG (0.2 mL, 0.16 g, 1.2 nunol) is then added followed by the addition of the compound clxxxii (1.0 mmol, 435 mg.) in anhydrous DMF (4 mL). The

reaction is allowed to rise slowly to room temperature and stirred for 2 days. The reaction is then dumped in a separatory funnel containing 120 mL of EtOAc and washed 2X with 1 N. HC1 (50 mL) and IX with brine. The organic layer is separated, dried over MgSCXt. The solvent is evaporated by reduced pressure and the product purified by chromatography on silica gel Goad in DCM, elute with 30%, then 50% EtOAc/DCM, and then 2% MeOH/EtOAc) to yield compound clxxxiii collected (314 mg, 56%).

Intermediate Example 172 - Compound clxxxiv:
The starting material clxxxiii (314 mg, 0.56 mmol) is dissolved in dioxane (5 mL) and 0.5 M NaOH (3.4 mL, 3 eq). The reaction is run overnight. TLC in 100% EtOAc (using UV) shows complete conversion to the slow running acid product at the origin. The reaction is acidified to pH 2 with 1 N HC1, and then extracted 2X with EtOAc. Solid NaCl is added to the aqueous to

facilitate the extraction. The organic extracts are then combined, dried over MgSO4, and then evaporated under reduced pressure to yield compound clxxxiv (0.5 mmol, 89%) that is used as is in the next step.

Intermediate Example 173 - Compound clxxxv:
In a round bottom flask under inert atmosphere, acid compound clxxxiv (265mg, 0.5 mmol) is dissolved in anhydrous DMF (6 mL). HOAT (75.6 mg, 0.6 mmol) is added and the reaction is stirred at room temperature for 25 minutes. The reaction is then cooled down in an ice bath. DIC (0.1 mL, 0.6 mmol) is then added followed by the addition of the compound xiii' (0.65 mmol) in anhydrous DMF (4mL). The reaction is allowed to rise slowly to room temperature and stirred for 21 hours. The reaction is then dumped in a separatory funnel containing EtOAc (120 mL) and washed 2X with 1 N HC1 (50 mL) and IX with brine. The organic layer is separated, dried over MgSO4. The solvent is evaporated by reduced pressure and the product purified by chromatography on silica gel (load in DCM, elute with 50% EtOAc/Hexane, then pure EtOAc, and then 4% MeOH/EtOAc) to yield product compound clxxxv (185 mg, 52%).

Intermediate Example 174 - Compound exxxxiv*:
To a solution of D-alanine (5 g? 56.1 mmol) in 1 N NaOH (152 mL, 152 mmol) at 0°C is added a solution of MeOC(O)Cl (6.5 mL, S4.2 mmol) in diethyl ether (30 mL). The mixture is stirred in ice bath for 3 hours and then adjusted to pH 9 with 1 N NaOH. After stirring at room

249
temperature for 1 hour, the mixture is washed with ether (3x50 mL), acidified to pH - 2 with 5 N HC1, extracted with EtOAc (5x50 mL). The organic extract is washed with water, brine, and then dried (MgSO4). The solvent is removed to yield compound cxxxiv, N-methoxycarbonyl-D-alanine, as colorless oil (6.48 g, 79%).

Intermediate Example 175 - Compound dxxxvi:
To a solution of N-methoxycarbonyl-D-alanine (0.193 g, 1.31 mmol) and HOAt (0.177 g, 1.31 mmol) in DCM (10 mL) cooled in ice bath is treated with DCC (1.31 mL, 1.31 mmol). After stirring in an ice bath for 0.5 hour, a solution of prepared compound clxxxii (0.88 mmol) in THF (8.8 mL) is added. The mixture is warmed up to room temperature and stirred overnight, then cooled in ice bath, and quenched with saturated NaHCO= solution. The precipitates are filtered and the filtrate is taken up in EtOAc (100 ml,). The organic layer is washed with saturated NaHCO3 solution, brine, and then dried (MgSO4). After removal of the solvent, the residue is purified by silica column chromatbgraphy (60% EtOAc/Hexane) to yield compound clxxxvi as gummy foam (0.321 g, 68%).

Intermediate Example 176 - Compound clxxxvii:
To a solution of compound clxxxvi (0.321 g, 0.597 mmol) in EtOH (5 mL) at 5°C is added 2 N NaOH (1-05 mL, 2.1 mraol). The mixture is stirred at room temperature for 4 hours. The solution is acidified to pH ~2 with 1 N HC1 and EtOH is removed by rotary evaporation. The mixture is extracted with EtOAc (3x30 mL) and the combined extract is washed with brine, and then dried (MgSO4). Solvent is removed and the residue is dried under vacuum to give compound clxxxvii as gummy foam (0.235 g, 77%).

250

Intermediate Example 177 - Compound clxxxviii:
A solution of compound clxxxvii (0.363 g, 0.712 mmol) in DCM (10 mL) is cooled in an ice bath and treated with PyBOP (0.594 g, 1.14 mmol). After stirring at room temperature for 0.5 hour, the mixture is cooled in ice bath and treated with a solution of compound xiii* (1.1 mmol) in THF (11 mL) and DIPEA (0.249 mL, 1.42 mmol). The mixture is stirred at room temperature overnight and quenched with NH4CI solution. The solvent is concentrated and the mixture is taken up in EtOAc (100 mL). The organic layer is washed with saturated NaHCO3 solution, brine, and then dried (MgSO4). After removal of the solvent, the residue is purified by column chromatography (5% EtOH/EtOAc) to give clxxxviii (0.341 g, 71%).
Intermediate Example 178 - Compound clxxxix:
Diaminopropionic acid (3 g, 28.7 mmol) is taken up in 1 M NaOH (86.2 mL, 86.2 mmol) and cooled to 0°C, and then MeOC(O)Cl (5.54 mL, 71.75 mmol) is added in Et2O (25 mL). The resulting mixture stirred overnight warming to room temperature. The reaction mixture pH is lowered to 2 and aqueous layer is extracted 3x with EtOAc. Extracts are combined and dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated to yield compound clxxxix (3.09 g, 48.9%).

Intermediate Example 179 - Compound cc:

251
Compound clxxxix (340 mg, 1.55 nunol) is taken up in DCM (4 mL). DCC (1.7 mmol) and HOAt (235 mg, 1.7 mmol) are added followed by compound clxxxii (1.7 mmol) in DCM (3.4 mL). The reaction mixture stirred overnight. The next day, the reaction mixture is filtered through a pad of silica and concentrated. Purification is achieved in 75% EtOAc/Hex to give compound clxxxx (715 mg, 72.4%).
Intermediate Example 180 - Compound clxxxxi:
Compound clxxxx (715 mg, 1.12 mmol) is hydrolyzed under standard conditions using EtOH (4 mL) and 1 N NaOH (3 eq) to yield compound clxxxxi (600 mg, 88.0%).

Intermediate Example 181 - Compound clxxxxii:
Compound clxxxxi (550 mg, 0.9 mmol) is taken up in DCM (8 mL). PyBOP (675 mg, 1.3 mmol) is added followed by compound xiii' (1.3 mmol) in THF (1.3 mL). DIPEA (0.23 mL, 1.3 mmol) is added and the resulting solution stirred overnight. The next day, the reaction is diluted with EtOAc, washed with saturated NaHCO3, and then brine, before being concentrated to yield a residue. The resulting residue is purified by 5% EtOH/EtOAc to yield compound clxxxxii (290me.41.5%1.

252

Intermediate Example 182 - Compound clxxxxiii:
Cbz-cyclohexyglycine-terMeucine methyl ester (7.36 g, 17.6 mmol) is hydrolyzed under standard conditions using MeOH (60 mL) and 1 N NaOH (52.8 mL, 3 eq) to yield intermediate clxxxxiii (92%).

Intermediate Example 183 - Compound clxxxxiv:
Compound clxxxxiii (3.82 g, 9.46 mmol) is taken up in DCM (30 mL). DCC (11.35 mmol) in DCM (11.35 mL) is added, followed by the addition of HOAt (1.54 g, 11.35 mmol). The resulting mixture stirred five minutes and compound v (9.46 mmol) in THF (40 mL) is added. The resulting mixture is stirred overnight. The next day, the reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc, washed with 1 N HC1, saturated NaHCO3, and then brine, before being concentrated to yield a residue. The reulting reside is purified by 20% to 30% gradient on silica gel to give compound clxxxxiv (3.03 g, 56.3%).


253
Intermediate Example 183- Compound clxxxii:
Compound clxxxxiv (3.03 g, 5.33 mmol) is hydrogenated using 10% Pd/C (500 mg) in MeOH (30 mL) under H2 for 4 hours to yield compound clxxxii (2.3 g, 99%).
Intermediate Example 184 - Compound clxxxxv:
To a solution of 1-amino-l-cyclohexanecarboxylic acid (2.86 g, 20 mmol) in MeOH (40 mL) is added dropwise SOCI2 (3 mL) at 0°C. The mixture is slowly warmed up to room temperature and then refluxed for 5 hours. Et20 is then added to the clear solution and the precipitate is isolated. The solid is further dried over vacuum to yield compound clxxxxv (95%) as white powder.
Intermediate Example 185 - Compound clxxxxvi:
2-PyrazinecarboxyIic acid (1 g, 8 mmol, 1 eq) is dissolved in DCM (15 mL) with addition of HOAt (1.1 g, 8 mmol) and DCC (8 mL, 1 M) in DCM. After stirring at room temperature for 20 minutes, compound clxxxxv (1.3 g, 8 mmol) is added to the activated mixture. DIPEA (2 mL, 12 mmol) is added subsequently, followed by DMAP (1.5 g, 12 mmol). After stirring over 3 days at room temperature, the reaction mixture is filtered through celite, concentrated and the desired product clxxxxvi is purified by column chromatography (50% EtOAc/hexane) as yellow oil (2.1 g, 100%).

Intermediate Example 186 - Compound clxxxxvii:

254
Compound clxxxxvi (1.06 g, 2.6 mmol) is dissolved in MeOH (30 mL) with addition of 2 N NaOH (aq) (12 mL, 24 mmol). The solution is stirred at room temperature overnight before TLC (50% EtOAc/hexane) indicates complete hydrolysis. The solution is then acidified to pH 3 by 5 N HC1 and diluted with EtOAc and followed by extraction of the organic layer. The organic layer is subsequebtly washed with brine and dryed over MgSO4 to yield compound clxxxxvii (84%) upon concentration.
Intermediate Example 187 - Compound clxxxxviii:
Compound clxxxvii (1.6 g, 6.4 mmol) is dissolved in DCM (18 mL) and then HOAt (0.96 g, 7 mmol) and DCC (7 mL, 1 M in DCM) are subsequently at room temperature. After stirring at room temperature for 20 minutes, L-tert-leucine methyl ester hydrochloride (7 mL, 1 M in THF) is added to the activated mixture. DIPEA (1.2 mL, 7 mmol) is added subsequently, followed by DMAP (1.2 g, 9-8 mmol). After stirring over 3 days at room temperature, the reaction mixture is filtered through celite, purified by column chromatography and concentrated to yield compound clxxxxviii (60% EtOAc/hexane) as white solid (1.74 g, 72%).

Intermediate Example 188 - Compound cic::
Compound clxxxxviii (1.74 g, 4.6 mmol) is dissolved in MeOH (22 mL) with addition of 2 N NaOH (aq) (7 mL, 14 mmol). The solution is stirred at room temperature overnight before TLC (50% EtOAc/hexane) indicated complete hydrolysis. The solution is acidified to pH 3 by 5 N HC1 and diluted with EtOAc and then the organic layer is extracted. The organic layer is washed with brine and dried over MgSO4 and then concentrated to yield compound cic (100%).

255

Intermediate Example 189 - Compound cc:
To a DCM solution (15 mL) of compound cic (1.5 g, 4.1 mmol) at room temperature is added HOAt (610 mg, 4.5 mmol), followed by 1 M DCC solution in DCM (4.5 mL, 4.5 mmol). After stirring for 30 minutes at room temperature, then a THF solution (20 mL, 0.2 M) of compound v (4 mmol) is added. The reaction is stirred at room temperature overnight. Then, the reaction is filtered through celite. The filtrate is concentrated to a yellow oil which is purified by silica gel chromatography (50% EtOAc/hexane) to yield compound cci (660 mg, 32%).

Intermediate Example 190 - Compound cci:
To an EtOH solution (6 mL) of compound cc (600 mg, 1.13 mmol) is added 2 N NaOH (1.7 mL, 3.4 mmol). The reaction is stirred for 2 hours at room temperature, then acidified to pH 3 by 5 N HC1. The mixture is then diluted with EtOAc, followed by extraction of the organic layer. Subsequently, the organic layer is washed with brine and then dried over MgSO4 to yield compound cci (92%) upon concentration.

Intermediate Example 191 - Compound ccii:
To a DCM solution (8 mL) of ccii (310 mg, 0.62 mmol) is added PyBOP (420 mg, 0.8 mmol). The solution is stirred at room temperature for 30 minutes. To this solution is then added compound xiii' (8 mL, 0.1 M) in THF, followed by the addition of DIPEA (0.23 mL, 1.3 mmol).

256
The reaction is stirred at room temperature overnight and then quenched with water (25 mL) for 30 minutes. The mixture is then extracted with EtOAc. The resulting organic layer is washed with brine and then dried over MgSO4, before being concentrated to yield a yellow oil. Purification by silica gel chromatography (3% EtOH/EtOAc) yields compound ccii (140 mg, 33%).

Intermediate Example 192-Compound ccxiv
To a solution of compound cciii, terf-butyl (TV-diphenylmethylene)-glycine ester, (6 g, 0.0206 mmol) and chiral PTC (1.08 g, 0.00206 mmol) in dry DCM (48 mL), under N2 atmosphere, at -60 °C, is added CsOH"H2O (6.9 g, 0.0412 mmol). To the reaction mixture is added dropwise 1-carboxy-l-cyclopentene methyl ester (5.2 mL, 0.0412 mmol) in 10 mL of DCM. The mixture is stirred for 4 days at -(60 °C, then diluted with 200 mL of Et2O and 15 mL of saturated NKjCI aqueous solution is added. Phases are separated and the organic phase is washed with 15 mL water and 15 mL brine. The aqueous phases are extracted with 100 mL of Et2O. The organics phases are joined and dried over Na2SO4. Crude product is obtained by
removal of the solvent dissolved in 100 mL of EtOH and then NH2OH"HC1 (1.43 g, 0.0206
i, mmol) and NaOAc (1.68 g, 0.0206 mmol) are added. The mixture is refluxed for 48 hours. Then
the solvent is removed and the crude residue obtained is directly purified by flash chromatography eluting with 30 9&-50 % EtOAc/hexane to yield compound cciv (65 %) as a white solid. Q2H19NO3 (MW =225.29); MS: m/z (M* + 1) = 226.5. Enantiomeric excess: 18 % ee, determined by Chiral HPLC.
Intermediate Example 193 - Compound ccv

257
To a solution of compound cciv (2 g, 0.0088 mmol) in 60 mL of ACN is added a catalytic amount of DMAP (0.216 g, 0.0017 mmol) and a solution of di-rert-butyl-di-carbonate (2.49 g, 0.011 mmol) in 30 mL of ACN. The mixture is stirred for 14 hours at room temperature, then diluted with 100 mL of DCM, and washed with saturated NaHCO3 (10 mL) and with brine (10 mL). The organic phase is dried over Na2SO4- Evaporation of the solvent yields a crude product that is purified on a silica gel column eluting with 15 % EtOAc/hexane to give compound ccv (86%) as white solid. C17H27NO5 MW =325,40 MS: m/z (M4 + 1) = 326.2

Intermediate Example 194 - Compound ccvi
To a solution of compound cc\ (1.7 g, 0.0052 mmol) in 50 mL of THF (0.14 M) at -78 °C, is added DIBAL-H (7.8 mL, 0.0078 mmol). The mixture is stirred for 1 hour, then 10 mL of MeOH are added. The mixture is diluted with 25 mL of EtOAc and 25 mL of saturated aqueous solution of sodium tartrate, and then stirred at room temperature for an hour. The phases are separated and the aqueous phase is extracted once with 50 mL of EtOAc. The organic phases are combined and dried over Na2SO4. Evaporation of solvent gave a crude residue that is used without any purification. The crude is dissolved in 25 mL of DCM, Et3Si (0.84 mL, 0.0052 mmol) is added, and then the mixture is cooled to -78 °C before the dropwise addition of BF3OEt2 (0.71 mL, 0.0061 mmol). After 30 minutes Et3Si (0.84 mL) and BF3OEt2 (0.71 mL) are added and the mixture stirred for 2 hours to -78 °C. The reaction is then quenched with saturated aqueous NaHCO3 (10 mL) and extracted with DCM (2x 20 mL). The organic phases are combined and dried over Na2SO4. Evaporation of solvent gives a crude residue that is purified by flash chromatography eluting with 13 % EtOAc/hexane to yield compound ccvi (87 %). C17H29NO4 MW =311,42 MS: m/z (M+ + 1) = 312.6


258
Intermediate Example 195 - Compound ccvii
Compound ccvi (0.5 g, 0.0016 mmol) is dissolved in 8 mL of 1 N HO in EtOAc (prepared by bubbling dry HC1 into dry EtOAc then diluting to 1 N with additional EtOAc). The mixture is stirred for 6 hours at room temperature. Solvent is removed in vacuo and the resulting precipitate is dissolved in Et2O. After stirring the mixture for 15 minutes, the solvent is removed under reduced pressure. The resulting white solid is washed with Et2O and the compound ccvii (0.27 g, 80% yield) is isolated by filtration. C,2H2iNO2 MW 211,15 MS: m/z (M+ + 1) = 212.6

Intermediate Example 196 - Compound v
To a solution of compound ccxvi (0.230 g, 0. 74 mmol) in DCM(3.7 mL) is added TFA (2.85 mL). The mixture is stirred overnight, then solvent is removed in vacuo to dryness and the residue is dissolved in EtOH (7.5 mL). The ;mixrure is cooled at 0 °C and SOC12 (0.22 mL, 2.96 mmol) is added dropwise and then refluxed for 2 hours. EtOH is removed at reduced pressure and the residue dissolved in DCM (10 mL). The resulting solution is washed twice with a saturated aqueous solution of NaHCO3 (5 mL). Phases are separated and the organic phase is dried over Na2SO4 and solvent removed in vacuo to yield compound v (80 %) as oil. Q10H17NO2 M.W.:183.25 MS: m/z (M+ + 1) = 184.2
Intermediate Example 197 - Compound cd
1-Benzylimidazole (6 g, 37.9 mmol) is taken up in Et2O (180 mL). The resulting solution is lowered to -60° C and treated with n-BuLi (1.6 M, 24 mL). The reaction is stirred for 30 minutes and then CO2 is bubbled through mixture for 15 minutes. The precipitate is filtered, rinsed with Et2O and then taken up in H2O. This aqueous solution is acidified to pH 3 with 5 N HC1. The desired product, cd, is isolated after lyophilization as a white solid.

259

Intermediate Example 198 - Compound cdi
A DCM solution (100 mL) of compound i (9.25 g, 27.9 mmol) is treated at 0° C with DAST (9.2 mL, 69.8 mmol). After stirring at room temperature overnight, the reaction is quenched with ice and extracted with DCM (200 mL). The organic layer is washed with brine and concentrated. in vacua. The residue is purified with silica gel chromatography (30% EtOAc/hexanes) to yield 8.5 g (86%) of the desired fluorinated intermediate. A portion of this intermediate (4.5 g, 14.2 mmol) is dissolved in EtOH (75 mL). This solution is subjected to standard hydrogenation conditions using Pd(OHVC (2.98 g, 20% Pd content, 4.26 mmol). After stirring overnight at room temperature, the reaction mixture is filtered through Celite. The filtrates are concentrated in vacuo to yield compound cdi (2.5 g, 96%).

Intermediate Example 199 - Compound cdii
To a solution of compound cd (890 mg, 4.4 mmol) taken up in DCM (15 mL). HOBT (595 mg, 4.4 mmol) and DCC (4.4 mmol, 1 M in DCM) are added and stirred for 20 minutes. A DCM solution (15 mL) of lxxix' (990 mg, 3.5 mmol) is added to this mixture. The resulting mixture is stirred overnight under nitrogen. The reaction mixture is diluted with EtOAc, washed with saturated NaHCO3 and brine. The organic layer is concentrated in vacuo to give a residue, which is purified in 30% EtOAcyHexanes to yield compound cdii (666 mg, 41%).

260

Intermediate Example 200 - Compound cdiii
Compound cdiii is prepared from compound cdii under standard hydrolysis conditions using methyl alcohol (10 mL) and 1 N NaOH (3 eq). 565 mg of compound cdiii are recovered (88%).

Intermediate Example 201 - Compound cdiv
Compound cdiii (1.24 mmol) is taken up in DCM (5 mL). DCC (1.6 mmol, 1 M DCM) is added followed by HOAT (1.6 mmoJ). The resulting mixture is stirred 20 minutes and


261
compound cdi (1.6 irunol) is added dropwise in THF (8 mL). The reaction is stirred overnight. The reaction is filtered and rinsed with EtOAc. The combined organic layer is washed with saturated NaHCO3, brine, dried over MgSOd, and concentrated. Purification is achieved in 30% EtOAc/Hexanes to yield compound cdiv (565 mg, 70%).
cdiv
Intermediate Example 202 - cdv
Compound cdv (565 mg, 0.86 mmol) is prepared from compound cdiv under standard hydrolysis conditions using ethyl alcohol (10 mL) and 1 N NaOH (3 eq). 490 mg (91%) of compound cdv is recovered.

Intermediate Example 203 - cdvi
Compound cdv (490 mg, 0.78 mmol) is taken up in DCM (10 mL). PyBOP (520 mg, 1 mmol) is added to DCM solution followed by a THF solution (10 mL) of xiii (186 mg, 1 mmol). DIEA (0.18 mL, 1 mmol) is added to the reaction mixture and stirred overnight under nitrogen. The next day, the reaction is diluted with, EtOAc, washed with saturated NaHCO3 and brine. Purification is achieved in 100% EtOAc to yield compound cdvi (478 mg, 77%).

262

Intermediate Example 204 - cdvii
Compound cdvi (478 mg, 0.6 mmol) is hydrogenated using Pd(OH)2/C (20% dry basis, 100 mg) in McOH (40 mL). The reaction mixture is stirred overnight under hydrogen. At this point, the reaction mixture is filtered through Celite and concentrated to yield compound cdvii (417mg,98%).

Intermediate Example 205- cdx
Compound cxxv (Purchased frorn Albany Molecular Research Inc., 1.5 g, 5.2 mmol) is taken up in DCM (15 mL). PyBOP (2.7 g, 5.2 mmol) and HOBT (700 mg, 5.2 mmol) are added to this solution. A THF solution (15 mL) of (-)-alpha-(4-pyridyl)cthyl amine (640 mg, 5.2 mmol) is added to above solution, followed by DIEA (0.93 ml, 5.2 mmol). [The (-)-alpha-(4-pyridyl)ethyl

263
amine is obtained from the tartrate salt of (-)-alpha-(4-pyridyl)ethyl araine (Aldrich) by stirring with 1 N NaOH (2 eq) for 1 hour followed by extraction with EtOAc (3x) 70% recovery]. The reaction is stirred overnight at room temperature. The reaction mixture is washed with saturated NaHCO3, and brine. The product is purified in 5% EtOH/EtOAc to yield 2 g (99%) of intermediate compound cdx.

Intermediate Example 206 - cdviii
Compound cdx (2 g, 5.2 inmol) is hydrogenated using 10% Pd/C (500 mg) in MEOH (50 mL). The reaction mixture is stirred overnight under hydrogen. The product is filtered through celite and concentrated to give compound cdviii (1.3 ,g 98%).

Pharmacology
Compounds according to the invention as described herein as being useful for being able to inhibit HCV protease, and thus, are also useful for inhibiting HCV replication.
Accordingly, an invention herein is directed to a method of inhibiting HCV protease comprising contacting an anti-HCV protease inhibitory amount of a compound of formula 1 with a composition comprising HCV protease.
Yet another invention herein is directed to a method of inhibiting replication of HCV comprising contacting HCVwith an effective amount of a compound of formula 1. Furthermore, another invention herein is directed to a method of treating a patient suffering from or subject to an HCV infection comprising administering to the patient a pharmaceutically

264
effective amount of compound of formula 1. References herein to treating an HCV infection should be understood to include prophylactic therapy to prevent or inhibit the infection as well as the treatment of an established acute or chronic HCV infection or physiological conditions associated with HCV infection to essentially cure the patient of the infection, inhibit the degree (amount) of infection or ameliorate the physiological conditions associated therewith. "Effective amount" is meant to describe an amount of the compound of the present invention effective within the scope of reasonable biological judgement, suitable for use in contact with the cells of humans and other mammals without undue toxicity, irritation, allergic response and the like, and are commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio in treating an HCV infection and thus producing the desired therapeutic effect.
Physiological conditions discussed herein include some, but not all, of the possible clinical situations where an anti-HCV treatment is warranted. Those experienced in this field are well aware of the circumstances requiring either an anti-HCV treatment.
A particular aspect of the invention provides for a compound according to the invention to be administered in the form of a pharmaceutical composition, though the compound may be administered alone. "Pharmaceutical composition" means a composition comprising a compound of formula 1 and at least one component selected from the group comprising pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, diluents, coatings., adjuvants, excipients, or vehicles, such as preserving agents, fillers, disintegrating agents, wetting agents, emulsifying agents, emulsion stabilizing agents, suspending agents, isotonk agents, sweetening agents, flavoring agents, perfuming agents, coloring agents, antibacterial agents, antifungal agents, other therapeutic agents, lubricating agents, adsorption delaying or promoting agents, and dispensing agents, depending on the nature of the mode of administration and dosage.forms. The compositions may be presented in the form of tablets, pills, granules, powders, aqueous solutions or suspensions, injectable solutions, elixirs or syrups. Examplary suspending agents include ethoxylated isostearyl alcohols, polyoxyethylene sorbitol and sorbitan esters, microcrystalline cellulose, aluminum metahydroxide, bentonite, agar-agar and tragacanth, or mixtures of these substances. Examplary antibacterial and antifungal agents for the prevention of the action of microorganisms include parabens, chlorobutanol, phenol, sorbic acid, and the like. Examplary isotonic agents include sugars, sodium chloride and the like. Examplary adsorption delaying agents to prolong absorption include aluminum monosterate and gelatin. Examplary adsorption promoting agents to enhance absorption include dimethyl sulphoxide and related analogs. Examplary carriers, diluents, solvents, vehicles, solubilizing agents, emulsifiers and emulsion stabilizers, include water, chloroform, sucrose, ethanol, isopropyl alcohol, ethyl carbonate, ethyl acetate, benzyl alcohol, tetrahydrofurfuryl alcohol, benzyl benzoate, polyols, propylene glycol, 1,3-butyIene glycol, glycerol, polyethylene

265
glycols, dimethylformamide, Tween® 60, Span® 80, cetostearyl alcohol, myristyl alcohol, glyceryl mono-stearate and sodiuni lauryl sulfate, fatty acid esters of sorbitan, vegetable oils (such
ij
as cottonseed oil, groundnut oil, corn germ oil, olive oil, castor oil and sesame oil) and injectable organic esters such as ethyl oleate,'and the like, or suitable mixtures of these substances. Examplary excipients include lactbse, milk sugar, sodium citrate, calcium carbonate, dicalcium phosphate phosphate. Examplary disintegrating agents include starch, alginic acids and certain complex silicates. Examplary lubricants include magnesium stearate, sodium lauryl sulphate, talc, as well as high molecular weight polyethylene glycols.
Other therapeutic agents may be used in combination with a compound of the present invention, including other anti-HCV agents. Some Examplary known anti-HCV agents include imrnunomodulatory agents, such as a -, (3 - or v-interferons; pegylated derivatized interferon-a compounds, other antiviral agents such as ribavirin and amantadine; other inhibitors of hepatitis C protease; inhibitors of other targets in the HCV life cycle including the helicase, polymerase, metalloprotease, internal ribosome entry, or broad-spectrum antiviral compounds such as VX-497, an inhibitor of cellular inosine monophosphate dehydrogenase, IMPDH, covered by United States Patent No. 5,807,876; or combinations thereof. Therapeutic agents used in combination with a compound of the present invention may be administered separately, simultaneously or sequentially.
The choice of material in the pharmaceutical composition other than the compound of formula 1 is generally determined in accordance with the chemical properties of the active compound such as solubility, the particular mode of administration and the provisions to be observed in pharmaceutical practice. For example, excipients such as lactose, sodium citrate, calcium carbonate, dicalcium phosphate and disintegrating agents such as starch, alginic acids and certain complex silicates combined with lubricants such as magnesium stearate, sodium lauryl sulphate and talc may be used for preparing tablets.
The pharmaceutical compositions may be presented in assorted forms such as tablets, pills, granules, powders, aqueous solutions or suspensions, injectable solutions, elixirs or syrups.
"Liquid dosage form" means the dose of the active compound to be administered to the patient is in liquid form, for example, pharmaceutically acceptable emulsions, solutions, suspensions, syrups and elixirs. In addition to the active compounds, the liquid dosage forms may contain inert diluents commonly used in the art, such solvents, solubilizing agents and emulsifiers.
Solid compositions may also be employed as fillers in soft and hard-filled gelatin capsules using such excipients as lactose or niilk sugar as well as high molecular weight polyethylene glycols, and the like.

266
When aqueous suspensions are used they can contain emulsifying agents or agents which facilitate suspension.
The oily phase of the emulsion pharmaceutical composition may be constituted from known ingredients in a known manner. While the phase may comprise merely an emulsifier (otherwise known as an emulgent), it desirably comprises a mixture of at least one emulsifier with a fat or an oil or with both a fat and an oil. Preferably, a hydrophilic emulsifier is included together with a Hpophilic emulsifier that acts as a stabilizer. It is also preferred to include both an oil and a fat. Together, the emulsifier(s) with or without stabilizer(s) make up the emulsifying wax, and the way together with the oil and fat make up the emulsifying ointment base which forms the oily dispersed phase of the cream formulations.
If desired, the aqueous phase of the cream base may include, for example, a least 30% w/w of a polyhydric alcohol, i.e. an alcohol having two or more hydroxyl groups such as propylene glycol, butane 1,3-diol, mannitol, sorbitol, glycerol and polyethylene glycol (including PEG 400) and mixtures thereof. The topical formulations may desirably include a compound that enhances absorption or penetration of the active ingredient through the skin or other affected areas.
The choice of suitable oils or fats for a formulation is based on achieving the desired cosmetic properties. Thus the cream should preferably be a non-greasy, non-staining and washable product with suitable consistency to avoid leakage from tubes or other containers. Straight or branched chain, mono- or dibasic alkyl esters such as di-isopropyl myristate, decyl oleate, isopropyl palmitate, butyl stearate, 2-ethylhexyl palmitate or a blend of branched chain esters known as Crodamol CAP may be used. These may be used alone or in combination depending on the properties required. Alternatively, high melting point lipids such as white soft paraffin and/or liquid paraffin or other mineral oils can be used.
In practice, a compound/pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention may be administered in a suitable formulation to humans and animals by topical or systemic administration, including oral, inhalational, rectal, nasal, buccal, sublingual, vaginal, colonic, parenteral (including subcutaneous, intramuscular, intravenous, intradermal, intrathecal and epidural), intracistemal and intraperitoneal. It will be appreciated that the preferred route may vary with for example the condition of the recipient.
"Pharmaceutically acceptable dosage forms" refers to dosage forms of the compound of the invention, and includes, for example, tablets, dragees, powders, elixirs, syrups, liquid preparations, including suspensions,, sprays, inhalants tablets, lozenges, emulsions, solutions, granules, capsules and suppositories, as well as liquid preparations for injections, including

267
liposome preparations. Techniques and formulations generally may be found in Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, Mack Publishing Co., Easton, PA, latest edition.
"Formulations suitable for oral administration" may be presented as discrete units such as capsules, cachets or tablets each containing a predetermined amount of the active ingredient; as a powder or granules; as solution or a suspension in an aqueous liquid or a non-aqueous liquid; or as an oil-in-water liquid emulsion or a water-in-oil liquid emulsion. The active ingredient may also be presented as a bolus, electuary or paste.
A tablet may be made by compression or moulding, optionally with one or more accessory ingredients. Compressed tables may be prepared by compressing in a suitable machine the active ingredient in a free-flowing form such as a powder or granules, optionally mixed with a binder, lubricant, inert diluent, preservative, surface active or dispersing agent. Moulded tablets may be made by moulding in a suitable machine a mixture of the powdered compounds moistened with an inert liquid diluent. The tablets may optionally be coated or scored and may be formulated so as to provide slow or controlled release of the active ingredient therein.
Solid compositions for rectal administration include suppositories formulated in accordance with known methods and containing at least one compound of the invention.
If desired, and for more effective distribution, the compounds can be rnicroencapsulated in, or attached to, a slow release or targeted delivery systems such as a biocompatible, biodegradable polymer matrices (e.g., poly(d,l-lactide co-glycolide)), liposomes, and microspheres and subcutaneously or intramuscularly injected by a technique called subcutaneous or intramuscular depot to provide continuous slow release of the compound(s) for a period of 2 weeks or longer. The compounds may be sterilized, for example, by filtration through a bacteria retaining filter, or by incorporating sterilizing agents in the form of sterile solid compositions which can be dissolved in sterile water, or some other sterile injectable medium immediately before use.
"Formulations suitable for nasal or inhalational administration" means formulations which are in a form suitable to be administered nasally or by inhalation to a patient. The formulation may contain a carrier, in a powder form, having a particle size for example in the range 1 to 500 microns (including particle sizes in a range between 20 and 500 microns in increments of 5 microns such as 30 microns, 35 microns, etc.) Suitable formulations wherein the carrier is a liquid, for administration as for example a nasal spray or as nasal drops, include aqueous or oily solutions of the active ingredient. Formulations suitable for aerosol administration may be prepared according to conventional methods and may be delivered with other therapeutic agents. Inhalational therapy is readily administered by metered dose inhalers.

268
"Formulations suitable for oral administration" means formulations which are in a form suitable to be administered orally to a patient. The formulations may be presented as discrete units such as capsules, cachets or tablets each containing a predetermined amount of the active ingredient; as a powder or granules; as solution or a suspension in an aqueous liquid or a non-aqueous liquid; or as an oil-in-water liquid emulsion or a water-in-oil liquid emulsion. The active ingredient may also be presented as a bolus, electuary or paste.
"Formulations suitable for parenteral administration" means formulations that are in a form suitable to be administered parenterally to a patient. The formulations are sterile and include emulsions, suspensions, aqueous and non-aqueous injection solutions, which may contain suspending agents and thickening agents and anti-oxidants, buffers, bacteriostats and solutes which render the formulation isotonic, and have a suitably adjusted pH, with the blood of the intended recipient.
"Formulations suitable for rectal or vaginal administrations" means formulations that are in a form suitable to be administered rectally or vaginally to a patient. The formulation is preferably in the form of suppositories that can be prepared by mixing the compounds of this invention with suitable non-irritating excipients or carriers such as cocoa butter, polyethylene glycol or a suppository wax, which are solid at ordinary temperatures but liquid at body temperature and therefore, melt in the rectum or vaginal cavity and release the active component.
"Formulations suitable for systemic administration" means formulations that are in a form suitable to be administered systemically to a patient. The formulation is preferably administered by injection, including transmuscular, intravenous, intraperitoneal, and subcutaneous. For injection, the compounds of the invention are formulated in liquid solutions, preferably in physiologically compatible buffers such as Hank's solution or Ringer's solution. In addition, the compounds may be formulated in solid form and redissolved or suspended immediately prior to use. Lyophilized forms are also included. Systematic administration also can be by transmucosal or transdermal means, or the compounds can be administered orally. For transmucosal or transdermal administration, penetrants appropriate to the barrier to be permeated are used in the formulation. Such penetrants are generally known in the art, and include, for example, bile salts and fusidic acid derivatives for transmucosal administration. In addition, detergents may be used to facilitate permeation. Transmucosal administration may be through use of nasal sprays, for example, or suppositories. For oral administration, the compounds are formulated into conventional oral administration forms such as capsules, tablets, and tonics.
"Formulations suitable for topical administration" means formulations that are in a form suitable to be administered topically to a patient. The formulation may be presented as a topical ointment, salves, powders, sprays and inhalants, gels (water or alcohol based), creams, as is

269
generally known in the art, or incorporated into a matrix base for application in a patch, which would allow a controlled release of compound through the transdermal barrier. When formulated in an ointment, the active ingredients may be employed with either a paraffinic or a water-miscible ointment base. Alternatively, the active ingredients may be formulated in a cream with an oil-in-water cream base. Formulations suitable for topical administration in the eye include eye drops wherein the active ingredient is dissolved or suspended in a suitable carrier, especially an aqueous solvent for the active ingredient. Formulations suitable for topical administration in the mouth include lozenges comprising the active ingredient in a flavored basis, usually sucrose and acacia or tragacanth; pastilles comprising the active ingredient in an inert basis such as gelatin and glycerin, or sucrose and acacia; and mouthwashes comprising the active ingredient in a suitable liquid carrier.
"Solid dosage form" means the dosage form of the compound of the invention is solid form, for example capsules, tablets, pills, powders, dragees or granules. In such solid dosage forms, the compound of the invention is admixed with at least one inert customary excipient (or carrier) such as sodium citrate or dicalchim phosphate or (a) fillers or extenders, as for example, starches, lactose, sucrose, glucose, mannitol and silicic acid, (b) binders, as for example, carboxymethylcellulose, alignates, gelatin, polyvinylpyrrolidone, sucrose and acacia, (c) humectants, as for example, glycerol, (d) disintegrating agents, as for example, agar-agar, calcium carbonate, potato or tapioca starch, algiiiic acid, certain complex silicates and sodium carbonate, (e) solution retarders, as for example paraffin, (f) absorption accelerators, as for example, quaternary ammonium compounds, (g) wetting agents, as for example, cetyl alcohol and glycerol monostearate, (h) adsorbents, as for example, kaolin and bentonite, (i) lubricants, as for example, talc, calcium stearate, magnesium stearate, solid polyethylene glycols, sodium lauryl sulfate, (j) opacifying agents, (k) buffering agents , and agents which release the compound(s) of the invention in a certain part of the intestinal tract in a delayed manner.
Actual dosage levels of active iingredient(s) in the compositions of the invention may be varied so as to obtain an amount of active ingredient(s) that is (are) effective to obtain a desired therapeutic response for a particular composition and method of administration for a patient. A selected dosage level for any particular patient therefore depends upon a variety of factors including the desired therapeutic effect, on the route of administration, on the desired duration of treatment, the etiology and severity of the disease, the patient's condition, weight, sex, diet and age, the type and potency of each active ingredient, rates of absorbtion, metabolism and/or excretion and other factors.
Total daily dose of the compounds of this invention administered to a patient in single or divided doses may be in amounts, for example, of from about 0.001 to about 100 mg/kg body

270
weight daily and preferably 0.01 to 10 nig/kg/day. For example, in an adult, the doses are generally from about 0.01 to about 100, preferably about 0.01 to about 10, mg/kg.body weight per day by inhalation, from about 0.01 to about 100, preferably 0.1 to 70, more especially 0.5 to 10, mg/kg body weight per day by oral administration, and from about 0.01 to about 50, preferably 0.01 to 10, mg/kg body weight per day by intravenous administration. The percentage of active ingredient in a composition may be varied, though it should constitute a proportion such that a suitable dosage shall be obtained. Dosage unit compositions may contain such amounts of such submultiples thereof as may be used to make up the daily dose. Obviously, several unit dosage forms may be administered at about the same time. A dosage may be administered as frequently as necessary in order to obtain the desired therapeutic effect. Some patients may respond rapidly to a higher or lower dose and may find much weaker maintenance doses adequate. For other patients, it may be necessary to have long-term treatments at the rate of 1 to 4 doses per day, in accordance with the physiological requirements of each particular patient. It goes without saying that, for other patients, it will be necessary to prescribe not more than one or two doses per day.
The formulations can be prepared in unit dosage form by any of the methods well known in the art of pharmacy. Such methods include the step of bringing into association the active ingredient with the carrier that constitutes one or more accessory ingredients. In general the formulations are prepared by uniformly and intimately bringing into association the active ingredient with liquid carriers or finely divided solid carriers or both, and then, if necessary, shaping the product.
The formulations may be presented in unit-dose or multi-dose containers, for example sealed ampoules and vials with elastomeric stoppers, and may be stored in a freeze-dried (lyophilized) condition requiring only the addition of the sterile liquid carrier, for example water for injections, immediately prior to use. Extemporaneous injection solutions and suspensions may be prepared from sterile powders, granules and tablets of the kind previously described.
Compounds within the scope of the present invention exhibit marked pharmacological activities according to tests described in the literature and below, which tests results are believed to correlate to pharmacological activity in humans and other mammals.
IN VITRO ENZYME ASSAY PROCEDURE Inhibition of HCV NS3 Serine Protease
HCV NS3 protease domain was expressed and purified as described previously (Vertex, PCT publication WO98/17679; which is incorporated herein by reference). The chromogenic peptide substrate, EDVVAbuC-p-nitroanilide, and the NS4A cofactor fragment

271
(-KKGSWIVGRIVLSGK-) for NS3 protease was custom synthesized by American Peptide Com (Ca). The compounds of this invention were tested for their ability to inhibit HCV NS3 protease activity using a spectrophotometric assay with EDWAbuC-p-nitroanilide as substrate. The assay was run in a 96-well microtiter plate using a SpectraMax 250 reader (Molecular Devices, Sunnyvale, CA) with kinetic capability. Cleavage of EDVVAbuC-p-nitroanilide (500 pM) substrate by purified HCV NS3 protease (0.5 JIM) was performed at 30°C in the buffer containing 30 uM NS4A fragment, 46 mM Hepes, pH 8.0, 92 mM NaCl, 18% glycerol, 5 mM DTT, and 7.5% DMSO in the absence or presence of the testing compound. The reaction was monitored for pNA (p-nitroaniline) release at 405 nm.
The determination of the kinetic parameters including Vmax, Km and V^/Km is performed under the conditions as described above. Ki values are calculated from rate vs. [inhibitor] plots, at fixed concentrations of enzyme and substrate, by a nonlinear least squares fit of the data to the equation of Morrison for tight binding competitive inhibition [J. F. Morrison, Biochim. Biophvs. Acta.. 185, 269-286 (1969)]. The Prism program (GraphPad Software, Inc.) is used for this procedure.
The HCV serine protease inhibitors disclosed herein can be used in combination with other molecules that directly exhibit or indirectly elicit anti-HCV activity either prophylactically in patients at risk for contracting HCV infection, or to treat patients that are already infected. The term "anti-HCV activity" refers to the capacity of a molecule, when present, to completely inhibit or reduce accumulation of HCV virions compared to HCV virion accumulation in the absence of such molecule, and/or the capacity of a molecule to reduce or ameliorate conditions or symptoms associated with HCV infection or pathogenesis in patients. Molecules having anti-HCV activity include those that disrupt one of more steps in HCV infection or replication, as well as those that evoke immunomodulating and antiproliferative actions in host cells. Molecules having anti-HCV activity can inhibit HCV-specific replicative events such as, but not limited to, HCV-directed nucleic acid or protein synthesis. Stages of HCV replication at which molecules having anti-HCV activity can act include cell entry (e.g., attachment; penetration); uncoating and release of the HCV genome; replication of the HCV genome (e.g., replication of either strand of the viral RNA genome; transcription of viral messenger RNA); translation of HCV proteins; posttranslational modification of HCV proteins (e.g., proteolytic cleavage; grycosylation); Litracellular transport of viral proteins; assembly of virion components; and release of viral particles (e.g., budding). Classes of molecules having anti-viral activity include, but are not limited to, soluble receptor decoys and antireceptor antibodies; ion channel blockers, capsid stabilizers, and fusion protein inhibitors; inhibitors of viral polymerases, reverse transcriptase, helicase, primase, or integrase;

272
antisense oligonucleotides and ribozymes; immunomodulating and imrnunostimulating agents, including cytokines such as interferons, as well as peptide agonists, steroids, and classic drugs such as levamisole; inhibitors of regulatory proteins; protease inhibitors; assembly protein inhibitors; and antiviral antibodies and cytotoxic lymphocytes. The term "anti-HCV effective amount" or "pharmaceutically effective amount" refers to an amount of a compound, or combination of compounds as disclosed herein, effective in reducing or ameliorating conditions or symptoms associated with HCV infection or associated pathogenesis in patients, or in reducing viral levels in \ntro or in vivo. In vitro applications include the Replicon Assay system, described below, where such amounts axe effective in reducing HCV replicon RNA accumulation and/or the accumulation of proteins encoded by genes contained therein.
Compounds having anti-HCV activity contemplated for use in the compositions and methods of combination therapy disclosed herein include, but are not limited to, immunomodulatory molecules, including imrnunostimulatory cytokines, and other compounds known to have HCV antiviral activity, such as various antiviral nucleosides and nucleotides.
Immunomodulatory molecules contemplated for use in combination with the HCV serine protease inhibitors disclosed herein include, but are not limited to, interferon-alpha 2B (Intron A, Schering Plough); Rebatron (Schedng Plough, Interferon-alpha 2B + Ribavirin); pegylated interferon alpha (Reddy, K.R. et al. Efficacy and safety of pegylated (40-kd) interferon alpha-2a compared with interferon alpha-2a in noncirrhotic patients with chronic hepatitis C Uepatology 33, 433-438 (2001)); consensus interferon (Kao, J.H., Chen, PJ., Lai, M.Y. & Chen, D.S. Efficacy of consensus interferon in the treatment of chronic hepatitis C. J. Gastroenterol. Hepatol. 15, 1418-1423 (2000)); interferon-alpha 2A (Roferon A; Roche); JymphoWastoid or "natural" interferon; interferon tau (Clayette, P. et al. IFN-tau, a new interferon type I with antiretroviral activity. Pathol Biol (Paris) 47, 553-559 (1999)); interleukin 2 (Davis, GX,, Nelson, D.R. & Reyes, G.R. Future options for the management of hepatitis C. Seminars in Liver Disease 19,103-112 (1999)); Interleukin 6 (Davis, G.L., Nelson, D.R. & Reyes, G.R. Future options for the management of hepatitis C. Seminars in Liver Disease 19,103-112 (1999)); Interfeukin 12 (Davis, G.L., Nelson, D.R. & Reyes, G.R. Future options for the management of hepatitis C, SemUiars in Liver Disease 19,103-112 (1999)); Ribavirin; and compounds that enhance the development of a type 1 helper T cell response (Davis, G-L., Nelson, D.R, & Reyes, G.R. Future options for the management of hepatitis C. Seminars in Liver Disease 19,103-112 (1999)). Interferons may ameliorate viral infections by exerting direct antiviral effects and/or by modifying the immune response to infection. The antiviral effects of interferons are often

273
mediated through inhibition of viral penetration or uncrating, synthesis of viral RNA, translation of viral proteins, and/or viral assembly and release.
Compounds that stimulate the synthesis of interferon in cells (Tazulakhova, E.B., Parshina, O.V., Gusev, T.S. & Ershov, F.I. Russian Experience in Screening, Analysis, and Clinical Application of Novel Interferon Inducers. J. Interferon Cytokine Res. 21,65-73)) include, but are not limited to, double stranded RNA, alone or in combination with tobramycin, and Imiquimod (3M Pharmaceuticals) (Sauder, D.N. Immunomodulatory and pharmacologic properties of imiquimod. J. Am. Acad. Dermatol. 43, S6-11 (2000)).
Other compounds known to have, or that may have, HCV antiviral activity by virtue of non-immunomodulatory mechanisms include, but are not limited to, Ribavirin (ICN Pharmaceuticals); inosine 5'-monophosphate dehydrogenase inhibitors (VX-497, being developed by Vertex Pharmaceuticals); amantadine and rimantadine (Younossi, A.M. and Perillo, R.P. The roles of amantadine, rimantadine, ursodeoxycholic acid, NSAIDs, alone or in combination with alpha interferons, in the treatment of chronic hepatitis C. Seminars in Liver Disease 19, 95-102 (1999)); LY217896 (U.S. Patent 4,835,168) (Colacino, J.M. et al. Evaluation of the anti-influenza virus activities of l,3,4-thiadiazol-2-ylcyanamide (LY217896) and its sodium salt. Antimicrobial Agents & Chemotherapy 34,2156-2163 (1990)); and 9-Hydroxyimino-6-methoxy-l,4a-dimethyl-l,2,3,4,4a,9,10,10a-octahydro-phenanthrene-l-carboxyHc acid methyl ester; 6-Methoxy-l,4a-dimethyl-9-(4-methyI-piperazin-l-ylimino)-l,2,3,4,4a,9,10,10a-octahydro-phenanthrene-l-carboxylic acid methyl ester-hydrochloride; l-(2-Chloro-phenyl)-3-(2,2-diphenyl-ethyl)-urea (U.S. Patent 6,127,422).
Formulations, doses, and routes of administration for the foregoing molecules are either taught in the references cited below, or are well-known in the art as disclosed, for example, in F.G. Hayden, in Goodman & Gilman's The Pharmacological Basis of Tlierapeutics, Ninth Edition, Hardman et al., Eds., McGraw-Hill, New York (1996), Chapter 50, pp. 1191-1223, and the references cited therein. Alternatively, once a compound that exhibits HCV antiviral activity has been identified, a pharmaceutically effective amount of that compound can be determined using techniques that are well-known to the skilled artisan. Note, for example, Benet et al., in Goodman & Gilman's Vie Pharmacological Basis of Therapeutics, Ninth Edition, Hardman et al., Eds., McGraw-Hill, New York (1996), Chapter 1, pp. 3-27, and the references cited therein. Thus, the appropriate forumulations, dose(s) range, and dosing regimens, of such a compound can be easily determined by routine methods.
The drug combinations of the present invention can be provided to a cell or cells, or to a human patient, either in separate pharmaceutically acceptable formulations administered

274
simultaneously or sequentially, formulations containing more than one therapeutic agent, or by an assortment of single agent and multiple agent formualtions. However administered, these drug combinations form an anti-HCV effective amount of components.
A large number of other immunomodulators and immunostimulants that can be used in
the methods of the present invention are currently available and include: AA-2G; adamantylamide
dipeptide; adenosine deaminase, Enzon; adjuvant, Alliance; adjuvants, Ribi; adjuvants, Vaxcel;
Adjuvax; agelasphin-11; AIDS therapy, Chiron; algal glucan, SRI; algammulin, Anutech;
Anginlyc; anticellular factors, Yeda; Anticort; antigastrin-17 immunogen, Ap; antigen delivery
system, Vac; antigen formulation, IDBC; antiGnRH immuTiogen, Aphton; Antiherpin; Arbidol;
azarole; Bay-q-8939; Bay-r-1005; BCH-1393; Betafectin; Biostim; BL-001; BL-O09; Broncostat;
Cantastim; CDRI-84-246; cefodizime;
chemokine inhibitors, ICOS; CMV peptldes, City of Hope; CN-5888; cytokine-releasing agent,
St; DHEAS, Paradigm; DISC TA-HSV; J07B; I01A; I01Z; ditiocarb sodium; ECA-10-142;
ELS-1; endotoxin, Novartis; FCE-20696; FCE-24089; FCE-24578; FLT-3 ligand, Immunex;
FR-900483; FR-900494; FR-901235; FrS-Zn; G-proteins, Cadus; gludapcin; glutaurine;
glycophosphopeptical; GM-2; GM-53; GMDP; growth factor vaccine, EntreM; H-BIG, NABI;
H-CIG, NABI; HAB-439; Helicobacter pylori vaccine; herpes-specific immune factor; HIV
therapy, United Biomed; HyperGAM+CF; ImmuMax; Immun BCG; immune therapy,
Connective; immunomodulator, Evans; immunomodulators, Novacell; imreg-1; imreg-2;
Indomune; inosine pranobex; interferon, Dong-A (alpha2);
interferon, Genentech (gamma); interferon, Novartis (alpha); interleukin-12, Genetics Ins;
interleulcin-15, Immunex; interfeukin-1.6. Research Cor; ISCAR-1; J005X; L-644257;
licomarasminic acid; LipoTher; LK-409; LK-410; LP-2307; LT (R1926); LW-50020; MAF,
Shionogi; MDP derivatives, Merck; roet-enkephalin, TNI; methylfurylbutyrolactones; M1MP;
mirimostim; mixed bacterial vaccine, Tern; MM-1; moniliastat; MPLA, Ribi; MS-705;
murabutide; murabutide, Vacsyn; muramyl dipeptide derivative; muramyl peptide derivatives
myelopid; -563; NACOS-6; NH-765; NISV, Proteus; NPT-16416; NT-002; PA-485; PEFA-814;
peptides, Scios; peptidoglycan, Pliva; Perthon, Advanced Plant; PGM derivative, Pliva;
Pharmaprojects No. 1099; No. 1426; No. 1549; No. 1585; No. 1607; No. 1710; No. 1779; No.
2002; No. 2060; No. 2795; No. 3088; No. 3111; No. 3345; No. 3467; No. 3668;
No. 3998; No. 3999; No. 4089; No. 4188; No. 4451; No. 4500; No. 4689; No. 4833; No. 494;
No. 5217; No. 530; pidotimod; pimelautide; pinafide; PMD-589; podophyllotoxin, Conpharm;
POL-509; poly-ICLC; poly-ICLC, Yamasa Shoyu; PolyA-PolyU; Polysaccharide A; protein A,
Berlox Bioscience; PS34WO; Pseudomonas MAbs, Teijin; Psomaglobin; PTL-78419; Pyrexol;

275
pyriferone; Retrogen; Retropep; RG-003; Rhinostat; rifamaxil; RM-06; Rollin; romurtide; RU-40555; RU-41821; Rubella antibodies, ResCo; S-27609; SB-73; SDZ-280-636; SDZ-MRL-953; SK&F-107647; SL04; SL05; SM-4333; Solutein; SRI-62-834; SRL-I72; ST-570; ST-789; staphage lysate; Stiraulon; suppressin; T-150R1; T-LCEF; tabilautide; temurtide; Theradigm-HBV; Theradigm-HPV; Theradigm-HSV; THF, Pharm & Upjohn; THF, Yeda; thymalfasin; thymic hormone fractions; thymocartin; thymolymphotropin; thymopentin; thymopentin analogues; thymopentin, Peptech; thymosin fraction 5, Alpha; thymostimulin; thymotrinan; TMD-232; TO-115; transfer factor, Viragen; tuftsin, Selavo; ubenimex; Ulsastat; ANGG-; CD-4+; Collag+; COLSF+; COM+; DA-A+; GAST-; GF-TH+; GP-120-; IF+; IF-A+; IF-A-2+; DF-B+; IF-G+; IF-G-1B+; IL-2+; IL-12+; IL-15+; IM+; LHRH-; LIPCOR+L LYM-B+; LYM-NK+; LYM-T+; OPI+; PEP+; PHG-MA+; RNA-SYN-; SY-CW-; TH-A-1+; TH-5+; TNF+; UN.
Representative nucleoside and nucleotide compounds useful in the present invention include, but are not limited to: (+) -cis-5-fluoro-l-[2- (hydroxy -methyl) -[1, 3-oxathiolan -5-yl]cytosine; (-) -2'-deoxy-3'-thiocytidine-5'-triphosphate (3TC); (-) -cis-5-fluoro-l-[2-(hydroxy-methyl) -[1, 3-oxathiolan-5-yl]cytosine (FTC); (-) 2', 3', dideoxy-3-thiacytidine [ (-) -SddCJ; 1- (2'-deoxy-2'-fluoro-beta-D-arabinofuranosyl) -5-iodocytosine (FIAC) ; 1- (2'-deoxy-2'-fluoro-beta-D-arabinofuranosyI) -5-iodocytosine triphosphate (F1ACTP); 1- (2'-deoxy-2'-fluoro-beta-D-arabinofuranosyl) -5-methyluraciI (FMAU) ; 1-beta-D-ribofuranosyl-l, 2,4-triazole-3-carboxamide; 2\ 3'-dideoxy-3'-fluoro-5-methyl-dexocytidine (FddMeCyt); 2', S'-dideoxy-S'-chloro-S-methyl-dexocytidine (ClddMeCyt); 2', 3'-dideoxy-3'-amino-5-methyl-dexocytidine (AddMeCyt); 2\ 3'-dideoxy-3'-fluoro-5-methyl-cytidme (FddMeCyt); 2', 3'-dideoxy-3'-chloro-5-methyl-cytidine (ClddMeCyt); 2', 3'-dideoxy-3'-amino-5-methyl-cytidine (AddMeCyt);
2', 3'-dideoxy-3'-fluorothymidine (FddThd); 2', 3"-dideoxy-beta-L-5-fluorocytidine (beta-L-FddC) ; 2\ 3'-dideoxy-beta-L-5-thiacytidine; 2\ 3'-dideoxy-beta-L-5-cytidine (beta-L-ddC); 9- (1, 3-dihydroxy-2-propoxymethyl)guanine;2'-deoxy-3'-thia-5-fluorocytosine; 3 '-amino-5 -methyl -dexocytidine (AddMeCyt);
2-amino-l, 9-[ (2-hydroxymethyl-l- (hydroxymethyl) ethoxyj methyl]-6H-purin-6-one (gancyclovir); 2-[2- (2-amino-9H-purin-9y) ethyl]-l, 3-propandil diacetate (famciclovir); 2-amino-l, 9-dihydro-9-[ (2-hydroxy-ethoxy) methyl]6H-purin-6-one (acyclovir); 9- (4-hydroxy-3-hydroxymethyl-but-l-yl) guanine (penciclovir);

276
9- (4-hydroxy-3-hydroxymethyl-but-l-yl) -6-deoxy-guanine diacetate (famciclovir) ;
3'-azido-3'-deoxythymidine (AZT) ; 3'-chloro-5-metbyl-dexocytidine (ClddMeCyt); .
9- (2-phosphonyl-methoxyethyl) -2\ 6'-diammopurme-2', 3'-dideoxyriboside;
9- (2-phosphonylmethoxyethyl) adenine (PI*1EA) ; acyclovir triphosphate (ACVTP);
D-carbocyclic-2'-deoxyguanosine (CdG); dideoxy-cytidine; dideoxy-cytosine (ddC);
dideoxy-guanine (ddG) ; dideoxy-inosine (ddl) ; E-5- (2-bromovinyl) -2'-deoxyuridine
triphosphate; fluoro-arabinofuranosyl-iodouracil;
1- (2'-deoxy-2'-fluoro-l-beta-D-arabinofuranosyl) -5-iodo-uracil (FIAU) ;
stavudine; 9-beta-D-arabinofuranosyI-9H-purine-6-amine monohydrate (Ara-A);
9-beta-D-arabinofuranosyl-9H-purine-6-amine-5'-monophosphatemonohydrate (Ara-AMP);
2-deoxy-3'-thia-5-fIuorocytidme; 2', 3'-dideoxy-guanine; and 2', 3'-dideoxy-guanosine.
Synthetic methods for the preparation of nucleosides and nudeotides useful in the present invention are well known in the ait as disclosed in Ada Biochim. Pol,
43,25-36 (1996); Swed. Nucleosides Nudeotides 15, 361-378 (1996); Synthesis 12,1465-1479 (1995); Carbohyd. Chem. 27, 242-276 (1995); Chem. Nucleosides Nudeotides 3,421-535 (1994); Ann. Reports in Med. Chem., Academic Press; and Exp. Opin. Invest. Drugs 4, 95-115 (1995).
The chemical reactions described in the references cited above are generally disclosed in terms of their broadest application to the preparation of the compounds of this invention. Occasionally, the reactions may not be applicable as described to each compound included within the scope of compounds disclosed herein. The compounds for which this occurs will be readily recognized by those skilled in the art. In all such cases, either the reactions can be successfully performed by conventional modifications known to those skilled in the art, e.g., by appropriate protection of interfering groups, by changing to alternative conventional reagents, by routine modification of reaction conditions, and the like, or other reactions disclosed herein or otherwise conventional will be applicable to the preparation of the corresponding compounds of this invention. In all preparative methods, all starting materials are known or readily preparable from known starting materials.
While nucleoside analogs are generally employed as antiviral agents as is, nudeotides (nucleoside phosphates) must sometimes have to be converted to nucleosides in order to facilitate their transport across cell membranes. An example of a chemically modified nucleotide capable of entering cells is S-l-3-hydroxy-2-phosphonylmethoxypropyI
cytosine (HPMPC, Gilead Sciences). Nucleoside and nucleotide compounds of this invention that are acids can form salts. Examples include salts with alkali metals or alkaline earth metals, such as sodium, potassium, calcium, or magnesium, or with organic bases or

277
basic quaternary ammonium salts.
Immunomodulators and immunostimulants useful in the combination therapy methods of the present invention can be administered in amounts lower than those conventional in the art. For example, interferon alpha is typically administered to humans for the treatment of HCV infections in an amount of from about 1 x 3O6 units/person three times per week to about 10 x 106 units/person three times per week (Simon et al., Hepatology 25: 445-448 (1997)). In the methods and compositions of the present invention, this dose can be in the range of from about 0. 1 x 106 units/person three times per week to about 7. 5 x 106 units/person three times per week; more preferably from about 0. 5 x 106 units/person three times per week to about 5 x 106 units/person three times per week; most preferably from about 1 x 106 units/person three times per week to about 3 x 106 units/person three times per week. Due to the enhanced hepatitis C virus antiviral effectiveness of immunomodulators and immunostimulants in the presence of the HCV serine protease inhibitors of the present invention, reduced amounts of these immunomodulators/immunostimulants can be employed in the methods and compositions disclosed herein. Similarly, due to the enhanced hepatitis C virus antiviral effectiveness of the present HCV serine protease inhibitors in the presence of immunomodulators and immunostimulants, reduced amounts of these HCV serine protease inhibitors can be employed in the methods and compositions disclosed herein. Such reduced amounts can be determined by routine monitoring of hepatitis C virus titers in infected patients undergoing therapy. This can be carried out by, for example, monitoring HCV RNA in patients' serum by slot-blot, dot-blot, or RT-PCR techniques, or by measurement of HCV surface or other antigens. Patients can be similarly monitored during combination therapy employing the HCV serine protease inhibitors disclosed herein and other compounds having anti-HCV activity, for example nucleoside and/or nucleotide antiviral agents, to determine the lowest effective doses of each when used in combination.
In the methods of combination therapy disclosed herein, nucleoside or nucleotide antiviral compounds, or mixtures thereof, can be administered to humans in an amount in the range of from about 0.1 mg/pers on/day to about 500 mg/person/day; preferably from about 10 mg/person/day to about 300 mg/person/day; more preferably from about 25 mg/person/day to about 200 mg/person/day; even more preferably from about 50 mg/person/day to about 150 mg/person/day; and most preferably in the range of from about 1 mg/person/day to about 50 mg/person/day.
Doses of compounds can be administered to a patient in a single dose or in proportionate multiple subdoses. In the latter case, dosage unit compositions can contain such amounts of

278
submultiples thereof to make up the daily dose. Multiple doses per day can also increase the total daily dose should this be desired by the person prescribing the drug.
The regimen for treating a patient suffering from a HCV infection with the compounds and/or compositions of the present invention is selected in accordance with a variety of factors, including the age, weight, sex, diet, and medical condition of the patient, the severity of the infection, the route of administration, pharmacological considerations such as the activity, efficacy, pharmacokineric, and toxicology profiles of the particular compounds employed, and whether a drug delivery system is utilized. Administration of the drug combinations disclosed herein should generally be continued over a period of several weeks to several months or years until virus titers reach acceptable levels, indicating that infection has been controlled or eradicated. Patients undergoing treatment with the drug combinations disclosed herein can be routinely monitored by measuring hepatitis viral RNA in patients' serum by slot-blot, dot-blot, or RT-PCR techniques, or by measurement of hepatitis C viral antigens, such as surface antigens, in serum to determine the effectiveness of therapy. Continuous analysis of the data obtained by these methods permits modification of the treatment regimen during therapy so that optimal amounts of each component in the
combination are administered, and so that the duration of treatment can be determined as well. Thus, the treatment regimen/dosing schedule can be rationally modified over the course of therapy so that the lowest amounts of each of the antiviral compounds used in combination which
together exhibit satisfactory anti-hepatitis C virus effectiveness are administered, and so that
i-
administration of such antiviral compounds in combination is continued only so long as is necessary to successfully treat the infection.
The present invention encompasses the use of the HCV serine protease inhibitors disclosed herein in various combinations with the foregoing and similar types of compounds having anti-HCV activity to treat or prevent HCV infections in patients. For example, one or more HCV serine protease inhibitors can be used in combination with: one or more interferons or interferon derivatives having anti-HCV activity; one or more non-interferon compounds having anti-HCV activity; or one or more interferons or interferon derivatives having anti-HCV activity and one or more non-interferon compounds having anti-HCV activity. When used in combination to treat or prevent HCV infection in a human patient, any of the presently disclosed HCV serine protease inhibitors and foregoing compounds having anti-HCV activity can be present in a pharmaceutically or anti-HCV effective amount. By virtue of their additive or synergistic effects, when used in the combinations described above, each can also be present in a subclinical pharmaceutically effective or anti-HCV effective amount, i.e., an amount that, if used alone,

279
provides reduced pharmaceutical effectiveness in completely inhibiting or reducing the accumulation of HCV virions and/or reducing or ameliorating conditions or symptoms associated with HCV infection or pathogenesis in patients compared to such HCV serine protease inhibitors and compounds having anti-HCV activity when used in pharmaceutically effective amounts. In addition, the present invention encompasses the use of combinations of HCV serine protease inhibitors and compounds having anti-HCV activity as described above to treat or prevent HCV infections, where one or more of these inhibitors or compounds is present in a pharmaceutically effective amount, and the other(s) is(are) present in a subclinical pharmaceutically effective or anti-HCV effective amount(s) owing to their additive or synergistic effects. As used herein, the term "additive effect" describes the combined effect of two (or more) pharmaceutically active agents that is equal to the sum of the effect of each agent given alone. A syngergistic effect is one in which the combined effect of two (or more) pharmaceutically active agents is greater than the sum of the effect of each agent given alone.
Example 42
Current standard therapy for hepatitis C virus (HCV) infection is treatment with the immunomodulator alpha-interferon (Chronic Hepatitis C: Current Disease Management, U.S. Department of Health and Human Services, National Institutes of Health, 1999). This therapy is ineffective in most HCV patients, who show either no response or a relapse even after prolonged interferon therapy. Additionally, there are severe side effects associated with interferon therapy.
In view of the pressing need for new, more effective antiviral drugs to treat HCV infected patients, the present inventors have developed a series of compounds that inhibit the serine protease of HCV (a complex of HCV viral proteins NS3 and NS4A). These compounds can be used alone, together with one another, and in combination with other classes of compunds to treat or prevent HCV infection. This example describes the testing of three representative HCV serine protease inhibitors, i.e., Compound CU, Compound EP, and Compound EC, alone and in combination with individual members of a set of interferons (interferon alpha-2B (Schering-Plough), interferon alpha-2A (PBL Biomedical Laboratories, New Brunswick, NJ), interferon beta (Research Diagnostics Inc, Flanders, NJ), and ovine-interferon tau (Research Diagnostics Inc, Flanders, NJ)) in an HCV subgenomic RNA replicon assay (Replicon Assay) to determine if the two compounds act in concert to diminish HCV RNA accumulation. The Replicon Assay measures the amount of HCV subgenomic RNA (replicon RNA) remaining in replicon cells (Lohmann et at Science 285:110-113 (1999)) after two days of drug treatment relative to the

280
amount of replicon RNA in untreated cells, m this assay, the potency of compounds as HCV antiviral drugs is directly proportional to the level of inhibition of replicon. RNA accumulation.
The two drugs are tested in combinations in the in vitro Replicon Assay system to determine whether, when used together, they exhibit additive or synergistic anti-HCV activity. The Replicon Assay is employed as a surrogate model for in vitro HCV infection to evaluate the combined effects of the immunomodulator, for example interferon-alpha 2B ((Intron A); Schering Plough), and the HCV serine protease inhibitor, for example Compound CU. As shown below, the results demonstrate that there is a clear synergistic anti-HCV effect of these two types of drugs as measured using formal mathematical determinations of synergy to analyze their capacity to reduce HCV RNA levels in the Replicon Assay.
The Replicon Assay
The Replicon Assay employing a cell line containing the self-replicating HCV subgenomic RNA (replicon) is described in Lohmann et al. Science 285:110-113 (1999). The Genbank accession number for the sequence of the replicon used in the experiments described herein is listed in this reference as AJ242654. This paper discloses methods for in vitro transcription of RNA from the replicon cDNA, transfection of the replicon RNA into Huh7 cells by electroporation, and selection of cells containing the replicon RNA using the antibiotic G418. Huh7 cells are a hepatoma cell line obtained from Dr. William Mason at Fox Chase Cancer Research Center (Philadelphia). These cells are publicly available from Fox Chase, and have been extensively described in the scientific literature (Nakabayashi et al. Cancer Res. 42:3858-3863 (1982)). In the experiments described herein, all of the template DNA is removed from the in vitro transcribed replicon RNA preparation prior to electroporation of this RNA into Huh7 cells by multiple treatment with DNase (three sequential treatments).
The Replicon Assay is performed as described in detail below. Briefly, Replicon cells are placed in 96 well trays at a density of 10,000 cells per well and incubated 37°C. The cells are incubated in DMEM (Dulbecco's Minimal Essential Media) supplemented with 10% fetal bovine scrum, glutamine, nonessential amino acids, and the antibiotic G418 (0.25 mg/ml). After overnight incubation, the medium is replaced with DMEM containing 2% fetal bovine serum and various concentrations of the serine protease inhibitor, such as Compound CU, and/or an interferon such as interferon-alpha 2B (Intron A, Schering Plough). Each compound is tested at six to eight different concentrations. For one extreme of the range of concentrations, high concentrations of the compounds that will result in almost complete inhibition of replicon RNA

281
accumulation after two days of treatment are selected. From these starting concentrations, serial dilutions are made so that the concentration ranges tested in the Replicon Assay include concentrations at which the compounds are highly effective, as well as concentrations at which there is no significant effect. Each HCV serine protease inhibitor concentration is tested without any added interferon, as well as with the addiition of six to eight different interferon doses. Similarly, interferon is tested without any added HCV serine protease inhibitor. After a 48-hour incubation with the compounds, the medium is removed from the plates, and total cellular RNA is extracted from the cells using the RNeasy-96 kit manufactured by Qiagen Inc. (Valencia, CA). This RNA is then analyzed by quantitative RT-PCR, or TaqMan® (Applied Biosystems, Foster City CA). The TaqMan® RT-PCR target is the neomycin resistance gene in the replicon RNA. The plates are configured so that there are 5 replicates of each drug treatment sample, and 16 replicates of the untreated samples! This permits greater statistical confidence in the quantitative RT-PCR data.
Analysis of the Replicon Assay data yields two values that are useful in assessing the potency of potential HCV antiviral agents. Ait each compound concentration tested, the level of inhibition in replicon RNA accumulation caused by the compound during two days of treatment relative to the amount of replicon RNA in untreated cells is determined. This is reported as percent inhibition. When a series of data points generated by treatments of cells at a range of
concentrations has been obtained, IC50 values, i.e., the compound concentration at which HCV
!i
replicon RNA accumulation is diminished 50% by the compound, are generated. Through repeated testing of the HCV serine protease inhibitors in the Replicon Assay, it is determined that the IC50 has a percent coefficient of variation (%CV or 100% x standard deviation in the IC5o/mean IC50) of about 20%. The IC50 is the value used to rank individual compounds tested in this assay based on their potency as HCV antiviral agents. Simple IC50 determinations are inadequate to assess the utility of compounds used in combination. The most effective analysis of the array of data generated using all the combinations of different interferons and serine protease inhibitors requires evaluation of the percent inhibitions as shown in Table 7 using mathematical methods described below that are designed to determine if combination treatments are agonistic, additive, or synergistic.
Details of the Replicon Assay are as follows:
Procedure for Quantitative Analysis of HCV Replicon RNA in the HCV Replicon Assay Usinc TanMan®® RT-PCR

282
The Replicon Assay is used to measure the capacity of potential HCV antiviral compounds to inhibit the accumulation of a HCV subgenomic RNA replicon molecule in a Huh7 cell line (Lohmann et al. Replication of Subgenomic Hepatitis C Virus RNAs in a Hepatoma Cell Line. Science 285, 110-113 (1999)). This assay comprises three operational components : (1) Replicon cell maintenance, assay plate set up, and compound application; (2) Extraction of total cellular RNA from replicon cells; and (3) Real time RT-PCR (TaqMan®) to measure the mount of replicon RNA in each sample. The Replicon Assay requires at least 4 days to perform; however, the process can be interrupted and samples frozen between steps. Each assay component is described below.
1. Replicon cell maintenance, assay plate setup, and compound application
1.1 Replicon cell line maintenance
The cell line used in the Replicon Assay is produced as described in Lohmann et al. (Replication of Subgenomic Hepatitis C Virus RNAs in a Hepatoma Cell Line. Science 285,110-113 (1999)). After 150 cm2 cell culture flasks (Costar) containing Replicon cells are incubated at 37°C and 5% CO2 and become confluent, the cells are diluted 1:10, v/v, into fresh 150 cm2 cell culture flasks. The medium is DMEM containing 10% fetal bovine serum (FBS), IX non-essential amino acids (NEAA), IX Glutamine (Glu), and 0.25 mg/ml G418. Three serial passages are performed, each time allowing the cells to become confluent, followed by dilution of the cells into fresh 150 cm2 cell culture flasks. These cells, referred to as "original cells," are then aliquoted and stored for future use in the Replicon Assay. TaqMan -based analysis is performed to determine the number of HCV replicon genomes per cell, which reveals the presence of-150 copies of the replicon per cell. This is based on the ratio of copies of replicon RNA to two times the copies of the human apoB gene (number of haploid genomes).
1.1.1 Original cells are stored in liquid N2. For cells used in the Replicon Assay, after 20 serial passages, cells are abandoned, and a fresh lot is revived from liquid N2 storage.
1.2 Plating of cells in 96-well trays for the Replicon Assay
1.2.1. For preparation of 96-well plates, a 75% confluent 75 cm2 flask of replicon-containing cells are trypsinized, and resuspended in 10 ml Medium A. Trypsinization is performed by removing the medium, adding 1 ml of trypsin-EDTA 0.25%, w/v, and then removing the trypsin-EDTA. After 5-10 minutes the cells release from the flask and are resuspended in medium.

283
1.2.2. Cells are counted using a hemacytometer, and the cell concentration is adjusted to 105
cells/ ml.
1.2.3. Each well is seeded with a 100 (.il cell suspension using an Impact2 multi-channel pipette
(Matrix), never plating more than four 96-well plates from a single cell suspension.
1.2.4. 96-well plates are incubated at 37°C overnight.
1.3. Compound dilution and application to replicon cell trays
1.3.1. HCV serine protease inhibitor compounds are dissolved in dimethylsulfoxide (DMSO) to
a final concentration of 20 mM. Interferons are suspended in phosphate buffered saline
solution containing 0.1 % w/v bovine serum albumin.
1.3.2. The 20 mM compound solution is diluted to lmM with DMSO.
1.3.3. 50 ul of compound dissolved in DMSO are added to 10 ml Medium B (the compound
concentration is 5 mM, and the DMSO concentration is now 0.5%), or 20 ul of 1 mM
compound and 30 Hi DMSO are added to 10 ml Medium B (compound concentration is 2
HM.)
1.3.4. Compound dilution to final concentration is completed by mixing compound/Medium B
solution with Medium C (contains 0.5% DMSO). Serial one to five dilutions of the
compound are made with Medium C in a 2 ml polypropylene 96-well block to obtain the
desired final concentrations of compound.
1.3-5. The cell plate is removed from the 37°C incubator and labeled on the top right corner of the lid and the right side of the base. The medium is poured off of the 96-well plates.
1.3.6. 100 \il compound/medium solutions from each well of the 96-well dilution block are
added to the 96-well cell plate using an Impact2 Pipette.
1.3.7. 100 ul medium C are added to all the untreated wells according to Table 3 for testing
compounds at either 1, 3, or 6 different concentrations. "Untx" refers to mock-treated
cells (DMSO added at the same concentration as in treated cells); "Con ."refers to
compound concentration.
TABLE 3
2 compounds, 6 concentrations, 5 replicates
Compound 1 Compound 2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12

284


285
1.4. The plates are incubated for 48 hours at 37°C, and then subjected to RNA extraction.
TABLE 4

2. Extraction of total cellular RNA from renlicon cells
2J Introduction
The goal of the procedure is to extract RNA from in vitro tissue culture samples so that the viral or ccllulaj RNA is quantitatively recovered and pure enough to be analyzed by quantitative HCV RT-PCR assay.
To permit detection of variations in the efficiency of the RNA extraction, standard amounts of bovine viral diarrhea virus (BVDV), an RNA virus with some similarity to HCV, are added to each cell sample before RNA extraction. Thus, the level of BVDV RNA detected in the final multiplex RT-PCR reaction should be consistent among all wells within the variability limits

286
associated with the Replicon Assay. This RNA extraction efficiency internal control is discussed further in the TaqMan® section, below.
The RNA extraction approach used is the RNeasy-96 method manufactured by Qiagen Inc. (Valencia, CA). This method employs 96 silica-based mini-columns that are positioned in an array compatible with 96-well tissue culture operations. The RNA extraction technology is a modification of the Boom method, in which all cellular proteins and Ducleic acid, including nucleases, are first denatured with a strong chaotropic salt (guanidinium thiocyanate). In this environment, nucleic acids have a strong affinity for silica, the material in the mini-column discs; however, proteins and other contaminants do not bind to silica, and pass through the columns. After washing the columns with chaotropic/ethanol solutions, the samples are partially dried, and the nucleic acid is then released from the column in a small volume of water.
To reduce variability in recovering HCV RNA, care is taken with the column washing and partial drying conditions. The presence of a small amount of ethanol on a column will contaminate the final RNA and interfere with the RT-PCR detection system. Caution is required in all phases of this procedure because the starting samples may be biohazardous, the chaotropic salt is highly caustic, and as a thiocyanate, it can generate poisonous cyanide gas if allowed to come in contact with acidic environments.


287
2.2 Procedure: 2.2.1 Cell Lysis
2.2.1.1. Prepare lysis buffer: For one 96-well plate, add 150 jil p-mercaptoethanol (p-ME) and 1
[d BVDV stock (vortex stock before adding) to 15 ml RLT buffer (a component of the
RNeasy kit, Qiagen). This stock is prepared by infecting MDBK cells (bovine kidney
cells , #CCL-22, available from the American Type Culture Collection, Manassas VA)
with BVDV and harvesting the culture at peak cytopathic effect (CPE). This stock has an
infectious titer of approximately lxl07pfu/ml. This gives BVDV a threshold cycle (Q) of
about 22 in the TaqMan® assay. The BVDV stock is stored in a
-80°C freezer.
2.2.1.2. Cells are washed with 150 u,l serum-free MEM medium (program 4 on 8 channel
electronic pipette P1250: Fill 1250, Disp 150 x 8). 150 \x\ lysis buffer are added to each
well (same program).
2.2.1.3. RNA is extracted immediately, or cells are frozen at -80 °C.
2.2.2. Preparation of reagents and materials for RNA extraction.
2.2.2.1. Note the lot# of the RPE and RNeasy 96 Kit.
2.2.2.2. RPE: 720 ml of 100% ethanol are added to one bottle of RPE (Qiagen), and mixed well;
RPE bottles are always shaken well before use.
2.2.2.3. 70% Ethanol: 150 ml diethylpyrocarbonaie (DEPC) water are added to 350 ml 100%
ethanol and mixed well.
2.2.3. Preparation of RNA with RNeasy 96 kit
2.2.3.1. Frozen samples are thawed at room temperature for 40 min. At the same time, one
column of Extraction Controls is thawed for each plate (Extraction Controls: The
RNeasy Extraction Controls are a set of 8 tubes all connected together. Inside of each
tube is 170 µl of cell lysate with a certain ratio of HCV positive and negative cells.
From the top to the bottom are two each of a low, medium, high, and zero number
controls, respectively. (See section 2.3 of the protocol below.)
2.2.3.2. The samples are mixed by pipetting 100 µ\ up and down five times. The entire sample is
transferred into columns 1-10 of the 2 ml Matrix square-well block (program 1 on P250:
Mix 100 x 5, Fill 170, Purge).
2.2.3.3. 150 \x\ of the replicon standard is transferred into column 1 l(no samples in column 12).

288
2.2.3.4. 150 µl of 70% ethanol (EtOH) are added to each sample (program 4 on P1250: Fill 1250,
Disp 150).
2.2.3.5. An RNeasy 96 plate labelled with the appropriate plate number is placed in the vacuum
manifold. Mix and transfer the lysate/EtOH to the RNeasy 96 plate (program 1 on
P1250: Mix 200, Times 5, Fill 330, and Purge). Any unused wells are sealed with
transparent tape (supplied by Qiagen), usually column 12.
2.2.3.6. Vacuum (approximately 800 mbar) is applied to load the sample onto the mini-columns.
2.2.3.7. The RNeasy-96 plate is washed with 1000 µ\ of RW1 buffer (Qiagen)/well (program 2
on P1250: Fill 1000, Disp 1000).
2.2.3.8. Vacuum is applied to the filter through the RW1 buffer, and the flow-through is emptied.
2.2.3.9. The RNeasy~96 plate is washed with 1000 nl of RPE buffer/well (program 2 on P1250).
2.2.3.10. Vacuum is applied to filter through the RPE buffer.
2.2.3.11. Repeat Step 2.2.3.9
2.2.3.12. Vacuum is applied to the filter through the RPE buffer, keeping the vacuum applied for 3
min.
2.2.3.13. Dry the RNeasy 96 plate: The RNeasy-96 plate is placed in a collection microtube rack
(supplied by Qiagen), covered with the supplied AirPore tape, and the unit is centrifuged
for 10 min at 6000 x g (Qiagen Sigma centrifuge; 4-15°C).

2.2.3.15. Elute the RNA from the RNeasy 96-well plate: The RNeasy-96 plate is transferred onto
the top of a new collection microtube rack. 70 µ\ of RNase-free water are added to the
middle of each well (program 3 on P1250: Fill 850, Disp 70).
2.2.3.16. Incubate 1 min at room temperature, and then place a fresh AirPore tape over the plate.
2.2.3.17. The unit is then centrifuged for 4 min at 6000 x g in a Sigma 4-15C centrifuge. The
eluted volume measures between 28 µl and 50 µl.
2.2.3.18. The RNeasy-96 plate is discarded, and the collection tube rack is sealed with the Qiagen-
provided caps (8 per strip).
2.2.3.19. The eluted RNA is stored at -SO °C or immediately analyzed in the TaqMan® assay.
2.3 Extraction Controls Preparation Dayl
7 2
2.3.1.1. Plate out 2.5 x 10 replicon-producing cells in a 150 cm tissue culture flask (T-150).
2.3.1.2. Plate out 2.0x10 Huh7 cells in a 75 cm2 tissue culture flask (T-75).
2.3.1.3 Incubate overnight at 37 °C.

289
Day 2
2.3.1.4. Lyse the cells with lysis buffer.
2.3-1.5. Remove the supernatant from the Huh7 and replicon-producing cells, and wash the
fnotiolayer with 10 ml serum-free medium (MEM).
23.1.6. Add 30 nil of lysis buffer (with 1 pi of BVDV stock/15 ml of lysis buffer) to the Huh? cells, mix by repeated pipetting, and place the cell lysate in a 50 ml conical-bottomed tissue culture centrifuge tube. 2.3.1.7. Add 10.5 ml of lysis buffer to the replicon-producing cells, mix by repeated pipetting,
and place the cell lysate in a 15 ml conical-bottomed tissue culture centrifuge tube, 2.3 .2. For the HIGH Extraction Standard; Aliquot 170 ftl of the replicon-producing cells cell
lysate into rows 5 and 6 of two Matrix 0.75 ml tube racks.
2.33. For the MEDIUM Extraction Standard: Add 1,0 ml of the replicon-producing cells cell lysate to 9 ml of the Huh7 lysate, and mix well. Aliquot 170 ill of this mixture to rows 3 and 4 of two Matrix 0.75 ml tube racks.
23.4. For the LOW Extraction Standard: Add 50 pi of the replicon-producing cells cell lysate to 10 ml of the Huh7 lysate, and mix well. Aliquot 170 & of this mixture to rows 1 and 2 of two Matrix 0.75 ml tube racks. 2.3.5. ZERO Extracts Con.ro!: Aliquot m ,L of the Huh7 cell lysate to rows 7 and 8 of two
Matrix 0.75 ml tube tacks, 23.6. Store controls at -80 °C
3. TanMan® RT-FCR and Date Analysis
25
3.1 Introduction: Real-time quantitative RT-PCR is used to measure the amount of HCV
replicon RNA in each sample. This technology is also referred to as thePCR-based 5' nuclease assay, and TaqMan®. The analytic instrument is the Applied BJosystems 7700 Prism Sequence Detection System (Applied Biosystems, Foster City, CA). This instrument is essentially a time-30 multiplexed laser-induced fluorescence spectrograph coupled with a thermal cycler. It monitors the accumulation of PCR ampKcon in each weil of a 96-well sample tray throughout the course of the PCR process.
3.2. Use of BVDV Internal Control: As mentioned in the previous section, an internal 35 positive control is incorporated into every sample. This serves as a measure of RNA extraction

290
efficiency, and shows if the sample contains contaminants that inhibit TaqMan® PCR. BVDV is mixed with the chaotropic cell lysis buffer prior to applying the lysis buffer to the cells. Although the positive control is in every sample, the BVDV internal positive control assay is only performed when the HCV replicon RNA assay data fall outside of expected limits, suggesting that there could be a problem with the samples. The 7700 is capable of simultaneously monitoring the accumulation of two different PCR amplicons in the same tube by using detection probes labeled with two different fluorescent reporter dyes ("multiplexing")- Specific criteria that elicit a TaqMan analysis for the BVDV internal positive control of a sample plate are described in the section on data analysis (3.6).
3.3 HCV Replicon RNA TaqMan® probe and primers. Because of the expected genetic stability and general lack of RNA secondary structure in the neomycin resistance gene (neo) encoded in the replicon, primers and a probe that bind in that region are employed. This segment of the replicon RNA extends from bases 342-1193 of the 8001 base pair replicon (SEQ ID NO: 1):


291
3.4. Procedures
3.4.1. Method for Preparing lx Master Mixtures for NEO and BVDV RT-PCR
TABLE6


292

3.4.2. Preparation of Reagents for Master mix
3.4.2.1. Clean the bench according to the two steps below, and wipe the pipettes with RNAse away.
RNAse Zap (Ambion, Austin, TX) RNAse Away (Molecular Bioproducts, San Diego, CA)
3.4.2.2.. Open core EZ RT-PCR reagents (Applied Biosystems) and put the 5x buffer on ice, thaw frozen reagents at room temperature for about 15 minutes, and then put them on ice. One EZ RT-PCR reagents kit can be used to analyze two 96~well RNA extractions.
3.4.2.3. Take one tube of 2 ^M VIC probe (NEO or BVDV, 550 µI per tube) from
-20°C and put on ice.
3.4.2.4. Take one tube 3 µM forward/reverse primer mix (NEO or BVDV, 550 µ1 per tube) from
-20°C and put on ice.

293
3.4.2.5. Take one tube (30 µ\) of standards RNA transcript (108 copies/10 µI) from -80°C and
place on ice.
3.4.2.6. Take one tube of room temperature Ambion water.
3.4.3. Assembly of master mixture for one 96-well plate reaction.
3.4.3.1. Use a lml pipette to transfer 5x buffer (Applied Biosystems) to a 14 ml tube; total
volume added is 1100µ1.
3.4.3.2. Use a lml pipette to add 25mM Mn(OAc)2 (Applied Biosystems) to a 14 ml tube; total
volume added is 660fxl.
3.4.3.3. Use a 2OOµI pipette to add 165µl of 10 mM dATP to the 14ml tube. Do the same for
lOmM dCTP, 20mM dUTP., and lOmM dGTP.
3.4.3.4. Use a 1 ml pipette to add 550 µl lOx 3 µM forward/reverse primer mix.
3.4.3.5. Use a 1 ml pipette to add 550 µ\ lOx 2 µM probe.
3.4.3.6. Use a 1 ml pipette to add 220 µ\ rTth DNA polymerase (Applied Biosystems).
3.4.3.7. Use a 100 |xl pipette to add 55 µl AmpErase UNG (Applied Biosystems).
3.4.3.8. Use a 1 ml pipette to add 605 µ1 Ambion H2O to the 14 ml tube; the final volume is
4400µ1 total.
3.4.3.9. Transfer the 4400 µ\ master mix to a 25 ml reagent reservoir.
3.4.3.10. Dispense 40 uj per well for all 96 wells using an 8-channel pipette.
3.4.3.11. Transfer 10 µ\ of extracted unknown samples to wells of the reaction plate using an 8-
channel pipette, column by column, column 1 through column 11. Cap each column
after transfer.
3.4.3.12. Add 270 µ\ Ambion H2O to the 30 µl 108 copies/10 |il RNA transcript for use in the
standard curve and mix. There are now 107 copies of the HCV replicon quantitation
standard RNA/10 µl.
3.4.4. Setting up the ABI7700 for each run
3.4.4.1 Before each run, reboot the computer for the ABI 7700 and rebuild the desktop.
3.4.4.2 Close and remove-any redundant programs from the hard drive; overuns data to trash.
3.4.4.3 Open Sequence Detector vl .7 program (SDS software).
3.4.4.5 Open the "Replicon Assay Runs" folder.
3.4.4.6 Open the "Replicon Assay" template plate. The thermal cycler conditions programmed
into the template are as follows:

294
Stagel:50°Cfor2min.
Stage 2: 60°C for 30 min.
Stage 3: 95°C for 5 min.
Stage 4: 95°Cfor 15 sec.
Stage 5: 60°C for 60 sec.
Cycle repeat number of stages 4-5: 40.
Template instrument:diagnosis: advanced options:
Select views: display mse.
Select views: display best fit.
Select miscellaneous: reference dye ROX.
3.4.4.7 "Save" (not "save as") the file in the "Replicon Assay Runs" folder.
3.4.4.8 Show setup: hit RUN
3.5 Preparing the ABI7700 data after a run using SDS software.
3.5.1. The assay plates are removed from the ABI7700 and discarded without ever being
opened. This greatly reduces laboratory problems with PCR cross contamination.
3.5.2. The data are analyzed using the Sequence Detector System software VI.7.
3.5.3. The threshold levels are initially set using default settings.
3.5.4. Data rejection criteria: Data points or series of whole plates can be rejected. If there has
been a significant deviation from protocol, reagent failure or mishap, or ABI7700 run
failure, data can be discarded. For rejection of any data points from an apparently
normal run, one or more of these criteria must be met.

3.5.4.1. Threshold cycle calculation;;. Normally use the default values for the SDS software. If
the Ct of the most concentrated sample is less than 15, then change the threshold value
stop limit as needed to a lower value so that the Ct of the highest concentration sample
is greater than the stop value. Update calculations after making this change.
3.5.3.1. Consider rejecting an entire abnormal TaqMan® run as indicated by a deviation from
the mean values for the slope and y-axis intercept of the line generated by analysis of
the neo RNA standards. The acceptable ranges for those values are:
Slope values should be between 3.0 and 3.6 y-intercept cycles should be between 36 and 41 cycles.
3.5.4.3. Aberrant individual TaqMan® wells as indicated by extreme Rn/ARn can be deleted
prior to data analysis so that they do not affect the SDS software calculations.

295
3.5.4.4. Examine and record the no-template control Ct values and confirm that they are >7.0 Ct (>100X) higher than the Ct for any compound treated sample.
3.5.5. The HCV RNA standards Ct values are compared with previous results.
3.5.6. The HCV RNA standard curve is compared with previous results.
3.5.7. If aberrant amplification is evident in individual wells, those wells are identified and
noted.
3.5.8. The "results" file is exported and transferred from the 7700 computer to another
computer for analysis using Microsoft Excel.
3.5.9. Any of the following changes in reagent preparations or dilution used is reported.
New probe or primer synthesis from vendor.
New probe or primer dilution and aliquots.
New standards RNA transcript preparation.
New standards RNA transcript dilution and aliquots.
New BVDV viral preparation.
New column 11 standards preparation.
3.6 TaqMan® data analysis.
3.6.1. Copy and paste TaqMan® HCV Ct number and copy number from the TaqMan®
results file into the appropriate cells of the Replicon Assay data analysis Microsoft
Excel macro, and run the macro.
3.6.2. Copy the TaqMan® results table from the macro sheet onto another sheet, input
compound serial number and lot number.
3.6.3 From this excel sheet, the mean, standard deviation, and percentage CV of Compound inhibition activity, as well as HCV copy number, HCV Ct number, and BVDV Ct number (if available), of all dilution points in 5 replicates and no-compound control, will be calculated.
3.6.4. Criteria for data rejection and implementation of BVDV Control TaqMan®. Check all the calculations. Data points or series of whole plates can be rejected. If there is a significant deviation from protocol, reagent failure or mishap, or ABI7700 run failure, data can be discarded. For rejection of any data points from an apparently normal run, then one or more of these criteria must be met. The standard deviation of percentage inhibition should be less than 30% in active compounds. The %CV of HCV copy number should be less than 30%. The standard deviation of HCV Ct of all samples should be less than 0.5; this is usually about 0.1 to 0.3 in most samples. If the HCV Ct standard deviation is more than 0.5, then go back to the raw data table, and check the

296
Ct numbers of 5 replicates. If the Ct number of any one well is 2 Ct different from the average Ct number of 5 replicates, then this well should omitted from the analysis. If more than 3 wells (not on same column) have unusual Ct numbers, then the BVDV TaqMan® internal control assay should be carried out. If the BVDV data show irregularity, then the compound should be tested again.
3.6.5. IC50 calculation: Copy and paste the data of average inhibition and standard deviation into a sigmoid dose response with a variable slope calculator that uses non-linear regression methods. Using this tool, calculate the IC50 by using both of two methods: fixing the top at 100% inhibition only, or fixing the top at 100% inhibition and the bottom at 0% inhibition. The method that gives the clearest fit is then reported for each compound. The most reliable IC50 comes from the calculation having the lowest standard error. If IC50S calculated from these two curve fit options show more than one fold difference, or if the IC50 SD is greater than the IC50, the compound should be tested again at adjusted concentrations.
Calculation of the Effect of HCV Serine Protease Inhibitors in Combination with Interferons
30 Then no interaction or Lowe additivity is defined by the following relationship, where the combination of concentration D1 of INF and D2 of HSPI produces the effect E.
The effect of a HCV serine protease inhibitor (HSPI) and an interferon in combination can be assessed in the Replicon Assay by generating a dose response curve for the HSPI in the presence of various levels of interferon, or by determining a dose response curve for an interferon in the presence of various levels of HSPI. The goal is to assess whether there is more or less inhibition of viral RNA accumulation than would be expected if the two drugs produce additive effects on the RNA. More specifically, the additivity definition of Lowe ((1928) Die Quantitation Probleme der Pharmakologic, Ergebn. PhysioL, 27, 47-187) is used. This is defined as follows. Let DE,INF be the concentration of interferon that results in effect E, and let DE,HSPI be the concentration of protease inhibitor that results in effect E.


297
The degree of synergy or antagonism is expressed in terms of iso-effect curves or Isobols. The combination (D1,D2) is a point on a graph where the axes are the concentrations of interferon and HSPI (Fig. 2). All such combinations that produce an effect level E form the E effect Isobol. It is necessarily the case that (DE,INF,0) and (0, DE,HSPI) are points on the Isobol. The Isobols are straight lines connecting points (DE^.O) and (0, DE,HSPI) when the additivity relationship (1) is satisfied.
Concave-up Isobols indicate synergy, and concave-down Isobols indicate antagonism. Following the guidelines of Berenbaum, M. C. ((1985) The expected effect of a combination of agents: the general solution. J. Tlieor. Biol, 114,413-431), and Greco, Park and Rustom ((1990) Application of a New Approach for the Quantitation of Drug Synergisra to the Combination of cis-Diamminedichloroplatinum and 1-fi-D-Arabinofuranosylcytosine, Cancer Research, 50,5318-5327), add a term to (1) to account for synergy or antagonism. The equation defines a response surface that can be fit to the percent control values at all treatment combinations. Contour plots from this fitted response surface are the Isobols.
The concentrations that give a specified level of activity E alone are given by (3)

The response surface model assumes a sigmoidal dose response for each compound defined by (2).

To satisfy the model of Greco et al (1990), the combined action of the drugs must then satisfy equation (4) for every combination of drugs that produces response level E.


298
The parameter a measures the amount of interaction. A zero value of alpha means no interaction or additivity since the equation reduces to (1) when a = 0. Given IC50S, Hill slopes (m), maximum value (Emax), and minimum value (B), this equation can be solved to give the effect that results from any treatment combination [INF] and [HSPTJ. Therefore, this equation defines a response surface. Given an experiment where [INF] and [HSPI] are varied, the parameters can be chosen using nonlinear weighted least squares regression. The parameter a can be related to a synergy measure S (Hewlett, P. S. (1969) Measurement of potencies of drug mixtures. Biometrics, 25, 477-487), which is taken directly from the Isobols at a 50% effect. S is the ratio, of the distance from the origin to the Isobol defining additivity, to the distance from the origin to Isobol of the fitted data, along the line at 45 degrees from the axes. (S=ON/OM see Figure 3). The relationship is a = 4(S2 - S).
The method discussed in Greco et al. (1990), above, for fitting the response surface and determining synergy parameter a with its significance level is followed in assessing the degree of synergy in a series of experiments testing HSPIs in combination with several different interferons. However, there is a need to weight observations with lower counts more than those with higher counts. The counts relate directly to the percent control, which is the effect E. Using methods described in Carroll, RJ. and Rupert, D. ((1988) (Transformation and Weighting in RegressiontChaprnzn and Hall, New York), the well to well variability can be seen to increase with the square of the mean percent control value. Therefore, the observations are weighted by one over the fitted percent control value (E) squared. The variance and weighting used to analyze these experiments is consistent with variability relationships observed by researchers investigating methods for analyzing Radioligand assays (Finney, D. J., (1976), Radioligand Assay, Biometrics, 32,721-740, and Dudley, R. A. Edwards, P., Ekins, R.P., McKinzie, I. G. M., Raab, G.M., Rodbard, D. and Rodgers, R.P.C. (1985), Guidelines for Immunoassay Data Processing, Clinical Chemistry, 31/8, 1264-1271).
Results
30 In an initial experiment, HCV serine protease inhibitor Compound CU is tested over a
concentration range from 3 (iM to 0.0123 uM, i.e., a,244-fold range. The interferon-alpha 2B concentrations vary from 30 units per sample to 0.0096 units per sample, i.e., a 3125-fold range. As shown in Table 7, when used as a single drug treatment, Compound CU exhibits an IC50 of 0.48 uM, and the interferon IC50 is 2. IS' U. Within the precision of the Replicon Assay, which is

20
25
30

299
approximately 20%, addition of interferon-alpha 2B results in an increase in the inhibition of replicon RNA accumulation in a dose-dependent manner. For example, treatment of cells with 0.333 fiM Compound CU results in 28% inhibition of replicon RNA accumulation. Treatment of cells with a combination of 0.333 jiM Compound CU, which is 71% of the IC50 dose (0.469 joM) and 0.24 U of interferon-alpha 2B, which is 11% of the interferon-alpha 2B IC50 (2.05 uM) results in a 49% inhibition of replicon RNA accumulation. Thus, 71% of one IC50 dose in combination with 11% of the other results in 49% inhibition of replicon RNA accumulation. Using an intuitive approach to determining if a combination treatment is synergistic or additive or antagonistic, one could predict that if effect of combination treatment were only additive, one would expect the combined fractions of the two IC50 doses needed to obtain a 49% inhibition of replicon RNA accumulation to be 98%. Our experimental results demonstrate that the level of inhibition of replicon RNA accumulation is achieved using 71% plus 11%, i.e. 82% of the IC50 dose rather than 98%, as predicted for additive effects of combination treatment. Thus at these concentrations of compounds, the effect appears to be synergistic because smaller fractional doses of the IC50 dose of each compound are used to obtain 49% inhibition of HCV replicon RNA than would be required of either compound alone, where 98% of the IC50 doses would be needed. The results of this combination treatment are shown in Table 8 and graphically in Figure 1.

300
TABLE 7
Inhibition of replicon RNA accumulation after 48 hour treatment with Compound CU and interferon-alpha 2B, individually or in combination
Interferon-alpha 2B(units)
Compound 30 U 6 U 1.2 U 0.24 U 0.048 U 0.0096 U 0 U

CU(conc) 3µM lµM 0.333 µM
o.mi µM
0.0370 µM 0.0123 µ.M
OµM

These initial results, derived as stated earlier via use of the in vitro Replicon Assay and a simple additivity analysis of the data generated by that assay, demonstrate that combination treatment of replicon cells with an HCV serine protease inhibitor and an interferon yields at least an additive antiviral effect, and likely a synergistic antiviral effect
The foregoing data have been reanalyzed using the formal mathematical tools described above to determine if the relationship between HCV serine protease inhibitor CU and interferon alpha-2B is synergeistic, additive, or antagomstic. The reanalyzed data are shown numerically in Table 8, and graphically in Figure 4.
Table 8 summarizes further results obtained in the Replicon Assay after treatment of replicon-containing cells for 48 hours with various HCV serine protease inhibitors of the present invention and several different interferons, individually or in combination. We point out that the standard deviation of values measured for inhibition of HCV replicon RNA in the Replicon Assay is -20%. Compounds are tested over a broad concentration range and at lower compound concentrations that cause no significant inhibition of HCV replicon RNA concentration. Because of the ~20% standard deviation of the assay, some data points will generate negative numbers. Negative inhibition numbers indicate in a particular experiment there is on average more HCV replicon RNA molecules in the compound treated samples than in the mock treated samples.

301
TABLE 8
INHIBITION OF REPLICON RNA ACCUMULATION
AFTER 48 HOUR TREATMENT WITH HCV SERINE PROTEASE INHIBITORS AND DIFFERENT INTERFERONS, INDIVIDUALLY OR IN COMBINATION
EXPERIMENT 1


302
EXPERIMENT 3
Compound CU (µM)


303
EXPERIMENT 5
Compound CU (µM)


304
EXPERIMENT 7
Compound EC (µM)


305
EXPERIMENT 9
Compound EP (µM)


306
As shown in Figures 4-13, which graphically depict the data in Table 8 plotted using the above-described mathematical method for measuring synergy, the Isobol curves for all combinations of HCV serine proteae inhibitors and interferons tested are concave-up, indicating that the antiviral effect of the treatments in the Replicon Assay is synergistic. These results are tabulated in Table 9, which shows relative levels of synergy for combination treatment and IC50 values for antiviral compounds used individually. The key elements in Table 9 are the a values, and the p-values for the determinations. The a term is a measure of the maximum inflection of the Isobols for each combination treatment. An a value of zero indicates additivity, a negative value indicates antagonism, and as is the case in the combination treatments with the HCV serine protease inhibitors and interferons shown above, a value greater than one indicates synergy. The larger the a parameter, the greater the synergy. As shown in Table 9 for the combinations of HCV serine protease inhibitors and interferons, even ignoring significance levels in each experiment, a t test based on the 9 experiments for the average alpha value being 0 (no interaction) has a p-value of 0.00014, indicating that the results are highly significant.
The calculation of synergy based on the method of Greco Rustom ((1990) Application of a New Approach for the Quantitation of Drug Synergism to the Combination of cis-Diamminedichloroplatinum and 1-B-D-Arabinofuranosylcytosine, Cancer Research, 50, 5318-5327) used in this analysis is an ideal tool for evaluation of the kind of experimental data that can be generated using the HCV Replicon Assay. There are other methods that are applied to studies of antiviral compounds such as Pritchard and Shipman (Prichard, M.N., and Shipman, C. Jr., (1990) "A three-dimensional model to analyze drug-drug interactions (review)," Antiviral Res. 14: 181-206). Application of their synergy calculation method to the data shown in Table 8 also indicates combination treatment of the replicon cells with an HCV serine protease inhibitor and interferon will result in a synergistic inhibition of HCV replicon RNA accumulation (data not shown).

307
TABLE 9
RELATIVE LEVELS OF SYNERGY FOR COMBINATION TREATMENT AND IC50 VALUES FOR ANTIVIRAL COMPOUNDS USED INDIVIDUALLY
HCV Serine IC50 INF IC50 HSPI a P-value
Protease Interferon (units) (µM) (SE)1 a>0
Inhibitor (HSPD

Another measure for evaluating the synergistic nature of anti-HCV drug treatment using the present HCV serine protease inhibitors and interferons is to use the same methods described above to evaluate the current standard combination therapy for HCV, i.e., interferon alpha-2B in combination with Ribavirin in the Replicon Assay. The last line of Table 9 shows that the a parameter for a mixture of interferon alpha-2B and Ribavirin is a negative number, indicating that there is a small amount of antagonism between these two drugs. This further emphasizes the significance of the combination treatments disclosed herein employing the present HCV serine protease inhibitors in combination with interferons in that these treatments clearly produce synergy, while the standard combination therapy in use for HCV (interferon alpha-2B in combination with Ribavirin) is not synergistic in the Replicon Assay.
The foregoing comparison of combination treatments employing the present HCV serine protease inhibitors plus interferons versus Ribavirin plus interferon in the Replicon Assay clearly indicates that the former are synergistic, while the latter is not. The experimental results obtained using the Replicon Assay indicate that a much lower dose of interferon would be efficacious if the

308
interferon is used in combination with a HCV serine protease inhibitor than is needed when interferon alpha-2B is used in combination with Ribavirin. The Replicon Assay is a useful model system in which to test potential anti-HCV compounds, and is currently widely relied upon as an effective predictor of compound anti-HCV activity. Note, for example, Blight et al. (2000) Efficient Initiation of HCV RNA Replication in Cell Culture. Science 8; 290:1972-1974, and Chung et al. (2001) Hepatitis C virus replication is directly inhibited by IFN-a in a full-length binary expression system. Proc. Nat Acad. Sci. U.S.A. 98(17):9847-52. Ribavirin alone is marginally effective in reducing the accumulation of HCV replicon RNA in the Replicon Assay (Table 8, Experiment 10 and last line of Table 9). This result is in apparent conflict with in vivo studies where, when used by itself, Ribavirin has no significant therapeutic value for the treatment of HCV. In contrast, in the Replicon Assay, correcting for cytotoxicity as discussed below, Ribavirin has an IC50 of 145 \JM. This result can be explained by recognizing that the Replicon Assay permits evaluation of high Ribavirin concentrations that would not be possible in human therapy due to in vivo cytotoxicity (Chutaputti A. (2000) Adverse effects and other safety aspects of the hepatitis C antivirals. Journal of'Gastroenterology and Hepatology. 15 Suppl:E 156-63). This evaluation necessarily requires assessment of the cytotoxicity of Ribavirin. Such toxicity occurs in patients and in cellular assays (Shiffman M. L., Verbeke S. B., Kimball P. M. (2000) Alpha interferon combined with ribavirin potentiates proliferative suppression but not cytokine production in mitogenically stimulated human lymphocytes. Antiviral Research. 48(2):91-9). In the experiments disclosed herein, Ribavirin cytotoxicity in the Replicon Assay is observed and measured in two ways. In both the XTT metabolic assay to determine replicon cell viability (Roehm N.W., Rodgers G. H,, Hatfield S. M., Glasebrook A. L. (1991) An improved colorimetric assay for cell proliferation and viability utilizing the tetrazolium salt XTT. Journal of Immunol Methods. 142(2):257-65) and in the TaqMan® quantitative RT-PCR assay that measures glyceraldehyde-3 -phosphate dehydrogenase (GAPDH) mRNA levels in treated versus untreated cells in the Replicon Assay (Brink N., Szamel M., Young A.R., Wittern K.P., Bergemann J. (2000) Comparative quantification of IL-lbeta, IL-10, IL-lOr, TKFalpha and IL-7 mRNA levels in UV-irradiated human skin in vivo. Inflamation Research. 49(6):290-6), significant Ribavirin-induced cytotoxicity is observed, but is corrected for as follows. It is-assumed that the level of GAPDH mRNA, which is a constitutively expressed housekeeping gene, is the same in all viable cells. It is known from measurements of GAPDH mRNA levels in cells treated with the transcription inhibitor actinomycin D that the half life of GAPDH mRNA is only a few hours (data not shown). Thus, it is postulated, as done by others using TaqMan technology to determine the levels of particular mRNAs in human cells, that GAPDH mRNA levels are

309
proportional to viable cell numbers (VCN) in any given sample, with the relationship of VCN= 2A(40-QGAPDH IDRNA)- The VCN is computed for each of the Replicon Assay sample wells, and then we divide the HCV Replicon RNA copy number for a specific well by the VCN for that well. Once computed, this ratio is used instead of the HCV copy number to compute inhibition ("Avg. Inh using ratio"; Fig 14.A). Without correcting the Replicon Assay data for this cytotoxicity, such cytotoxicity is read as false positive inhibition of HCV RNA replicon accumulation. In the Replicon Assay, it is assumed that the measured inhibition of HCV RNA replicon accumulation is the sum of the actual inhibition of HCV RNA replicon accumulation and the apparent inhibition of HCV RNA replicon accumulation due to cytoxicity. It is furthermore assumed that, based on the close correlation of the XTT and TaqMan® GAPPH mRNA measures of cytotoxicity, the inhibition of accumulation of GAPDH mRNA caused by compounds tested in the Replicon Assay is a reliable measure of apparent inhibition of HCV RNA replicon accumulation due to cytoxicity. Thus, the true anti-HCV activity of a compound in the Replicon Assay corrected for general cytotoxicity can be estimated by dividing the number of HCV replicon RNA molecules measured in each sample by the VCN, thus normalizing to the number of viable cells in each sample. Using this method, Fig. 14.A shows an estimate of true Ribavirin anti-HCV activity in the Replicon Assay ("Avg. Inh using ratio")- The estimate of the IC50 for Ribavirin is best calculated using this method. In Fig. 14.A, "Avg. Inh original" shows the uncorrected IC50 for Ribavirin, which is approximately 80 ULM, whereas the corrected IC50 value calculated from the "Avg. Inh using ratio" curve is approximately 145 [iM. Note that the difference between corrected and measured inhibition of HCV RNA replicon accumulation as a result of interferon alpha-2B treatment (Fig. I4.B) is insignificant in view of the -20% %CV of the Replicon Assay. Like interferon alpha-2B, the HCV serine protease inhibitors tested in the present example exhibit no significant cytotoxicity at the concentrations employed. This is determined using XTT assays, in which the TC50 values for the various compounds are: CU=64.7 uM , EP>10 pM, and EC>50 u.M. These TC50 values are 20-140 fold greater than the IC50 values shown in Table 9. Thus, cytotoxicity of these compounds has no significant effect on HCV RNA accumulation in the Replicon Assay within the precision of the assay because such cytotoxicity occurs only at HCV serine protease inhibitor concentrations significantly greater than those tested in the Replicon Assay.
Conclusions Regarding the Efficacy of HCV Serine Protease Inhibitors and Interferons. Individually and in Combination
The anti-HCV activities of the present HCV serine protease inhibitors and various interferons when used alone in the HCV Replicon Assay are shown in the columns and lines of

310
the individual experiments making up Table 8 that employ only one antiviral agent. Table 9 lists the IC50 values measured for each antiviral compound when tested alone. The foregoing results, derived via use of the in vitro Replicon Assay, also demonstrate that combination treatment of replicon cells with HCV serine protease inhibitors of the present invention and various interferons yields synergistic antiviral effects. It is fully expected that these effects will translate into in vivo effectiveness.
Combination therapy employing HCV serine protease inhibitors of the present invention possesses several major advantages over single drug therapy. First, by making treatment possible with lower doses of the individual drugs than would be possible if used alone, one would expect a reduction in toxicity and side effects associated with treatment. This is especially important in the case of interferon therapy, where the side effects are severe, and have been shown to be proportional to the dose administered to patients. The foregoing data indicate that a dose of HCV serine protease inhibitor such as CU at the IC95 level could be combined with a dose of interferon alpha, for example at the IC50 level, and the result would be much more effective therapy than could be achieved with the HCV serine protease inhibitor alone without the adverse side effects caused by high doses of interferon alpha. A second major benefit of combination therapy is that because the two drugs act independently, there is less chance of development of mutant HCV strains that resist treatment. Development of resistance is a major concern with RNA viruses like HCV. Because of their high rate of mutation, such viruses can rapidly adapt to environmental stresses. A third benefit of combination therapy may be reduced cost, due to the need for lower amounts of therapeutic agents required for effective treatment.
Additional immunomodulators that can be employed in the methods disclosed herein include, for example, alpha interferon 2A, consensus interferon, tau interferon, interferon + Ribavirin (Rebatron), pegylated interferon, and promoters of interferon gene expression. It is fully anticipated that the anti-HCV activity of these compounds will be improved when used in combination with HCV serine protease inhibitors such as those disclosed herein. As interferons are known to be active in vivo and in the Replicon Assay, it is expected that the present HCV serine protease inhibitors will also be active in vivo, and more importantly, be capable of eliciting synergistic activity when used in combination with interferons, immune system stimulators thereof, or other compounds having HCV antiviral activity that act by a mechanism other than inhibition of the HCV serine protease.
The best current therapy for HCV employs interferon alpha and the nucleoside analog Ribavirin. This treatment is only marginally effective, and results in significant side effects that diminish patient compliance (Chronic Hepatitis C: Current Disease Management, U.S.

311
Department of Health and Human Services, National Institutes of Health, 1999). Additionally, in transplant patients, it is not clear the Ribavirin-interferon combination works, and may in fact be worse than interferon alone (Chronic Hepatitis C: Current Disease Management, U.S. Department of Health and Human Services, National Institutes of Health, 1999).
The results presented above demonstrate a synergistic combination effect when interferons are used with a new class of HCV antivirals, the serine protease inhibitors of the present invention. We fully expect that the in vitro results disclosed herein will lead to more effective treatment of HCV patients than is currently possible using interferon alone. Sub-therapeutic doses of interferon could mobilize the patient's immune system to better fight the virus, and the serine protease inhibitor could attack the virus directly, dealing the virus a two-pronged attack via different mechanisms of action. Treatment of HCV infection could thus be achieved at reduced cost to the patient in terms of both diminished side effects and lower payments for necessary pharmaceutical agents as less of both drugs would be needed for effective HCV antiviral therapy.
The present invention may be embodied in other specific forms without departing from the spirit or essential attributes thereof.

312 We Claim:
1. A compound

or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or prodrug such as herein described thereof, or a solvate of such a compound, its salt or its prodrug such as herein described.
2. A compound

or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or prodrug such as herein described thereof, or a solvate of such a compound, its salt or its prodrug such as herein described.

313
3. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a pharmaceutically
acceptable amount of the compound of any one of claims 1 or 2
and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
4. A pharmaceutical composition, comprising a compound of any of
claims 1 or 2, an interferon having anti-hepatitis C virus activity,
and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
5. The pharmaceutical composition for the treatment or prevention of
a hepatitis C virus infection comprising a compound of claims 1 or
2 in combination with a compound having anti-hepatitis C virus
activity wherein said compound in other than an interferon such as
herein described.
6. The pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of any of
claims 1 or 2, a compound having anti-hepatitis C virus activity,
and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein said compound
is other than an interferon.
7. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 5, wherein said
compound of any of claims 1 or 2, said interferon, and said
compound having anti-hepatitis C virus activity are each present in

314
an amount selected from the group consisting of a pharmaceutically effective amount, a subclinical pharmaceutically effective amount, and a combination thereof.
8. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 7, wherein said
interferon is selected from the group consisting of interferon alpha
2B, pegylated interferon alpha, consensus interferon, interferon
alpha 2A, lymphoblastoid interferon, and interferon tau; and said
compound having anti-hepatitis C virus activity is selected from
the group consisting of interleukin 2, interleukin 6, interleukin 12,
a compound that enhances the development of a type 1 helper T
cell response, double stranded RNA, double stranded RNA
complexed with tobramycin, Imiquimod, ribavirin, an inosine 5'-
monophosphate dehydrogenase inhibitor, amantadine, and
rimantadine.
9. The pharmaceutical composition for treating a patient suffering
from an HCV infection or physiological conditions related to the
infection comprising a compound of claims 1 or 2 in combination
with a pharmaceutically effective amount of a compound of
another anti-HCV therapeutic.

315
10. A method for preparing a pharmaceutical composition comprising
a compound of any of claims 1 or 2 an interferon having anti-
hepatitis activity, wherein said compound are each present in an
amount selected from the group consisting of a pharmaceutically
effective amount, a subclinical pharmaceutically effective amount,
and a combination thereof.
11. The method as claimed in claim 14, wherein said interferon is
selected from the group consisting of interferon alpha 2B,
pegylated interferon alpha, consensus interferon tau; and said
compound having anti-hepatitis C virus activity is selected from
the group consisting of interleukin 2, interleukin 6, interleukin 12,
a compound that enhances the development of a type 1 helper T
cell response, double stranded RNA, double stranded RNA
complexed with tobramycin, Imiquimod, ribavirin, an inosine 5'-
monophosphate dehydrogenase inhibitor, amantadine, and
rimantadine.
12. The method as claimed in claim 15 further comprising a compound
having anti-hepatitis C virus activity of claim 1 or 2 in
combination with an interferon having anti-hepatitis .C virus
activity and a compound having anti-hepatitis C virus activity.

316
13. A medicament as claimed in claim 1, wherein said interferon is
selected from the group consisting of interferon alpha 2B,
pegylated interferon alpha, consensus interferon, interferon alpha
2A, lymphoblastoid interferon, and interferon tau; ad said
compound having anti-hepatitis C virus activity is selected from
the group consisting of interleukin 2, interleukin 6, interleukin 12,
a compound that enhances the development of a type 1 helper T
cell response, double stranded RNA, double stranded RNA
complexed with tobramycin, Imiquimod, ribavirin, an inosine 5'-
monophosphate dehydrogenase inhibitor, amantadine, and
rimantadine.
14. A compound as claimed in claim 1 or 2 having anti-hepatitis C
virus activity, wherein said compound is other than an interferon,
in the manufacture of a medicament for inhibiting hepatitis C virus
replication in a cell.
15. The compound as claimed in claim 14 wherein said hepatitis C
virus serine protease inhibitor, said interferon, and said compound
having anti-hepatitis C vims activity are each present in an amount
selected from the group consisting of a pharmaceutically effective
amount, a subclinical pharmaceutically effective amount, and a
combination thereof.

317
16. The compound as claimed in claim 21, wherein said interferon is
selected from the group consisting of interferon alpha 2B,
pegylated interferon alpha, consensus interferon, interferon alpha
2A, lymphoblastoid interferon, and interferon tau; and said
compound having anti-hepatitis C virus activity is selected from
the group consisting of interleukin 2, interleukin 6, interleukin 12,
a compound that enhances the development of a type 1 helper T
cell response, double stranded RNA, double stranded RNA
complexed with tobramyein, Imiquimod, ribavirin, an inosine 5'-
monophosphate dehydrogenase inhibitor, amantadine and
rimantadine.
17. A kit or pharmaceutical pack, comprising a plurality of separate
containers, wherein at least one of said containers contains a
hepatitis C virus serine protease inhibitor of claim I or 2 and at
least another of said containers contains an interferon having anti-
hepatitis C virus activity.
18. A kit or pharmaceutical pack, comprising a plurality of separate
containers, wherein at least one of said containers contains a
hepatitis C virus serine protease inhibitor of claim 1 or 2 and at
least another of said containers contains a compound having anti-
hepatitis C virus activity, wherein said compound is other than an
interferon as herein described.

318
19. A kit or pharmaceutical pack, comprising a plurality of separate containers, wherein at least one of said containers contains a hepatitis C virus serine protease inhibitor of claim 1 or 2, at least another of said containers contains an interferon having anti-hepatitis C virus activity, and at least another of said containers contains a compound having anti-hepatitis C virus activity, wherein said compound is other than an interferon.
20. The kit or pharmaceutical pack of claim 19, wherein said hepatitis
C virus serine protease inhibitor, said interferon, and said
compound having anti-hepatitis C virus activity are each present in
an amount selected from the group consisting of a
pharmaceutically effective amount, a subclinical pharmaceutically
effective amount, and a combination thereof.
21. The kit or pharmaceutical pack of claim 17 & 18 , wherein said
interferon is selected from the group consisting of interferon alpha
2B, pegylated interferon alpha, consensus interferon, interferon
alpha 2A, lymphoblastoid interferon, and interferon tau; and said
compound having anti-hepatitis C virus activity is selected from
the group consisting of interleukin 2, interleukin 6, interleukin 12,
a compound that enhances the development of a type 1 helpher T
cell response, double stranded RNA, double stranded RNA

319
complexed with tobramycin, Imiquimod, ribavirin, an inosine 5'-monophosphate dehydrogenase inhibitor, amantadine, and
rimantadine.
A compound
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or prodrug such as herein described thereof, or a solvate of such a compound, its salt or its prodrug such as herein described.


Documents:

00242-kolnp-2003 abstract.pdf

00242-kolnp-2003 claims.pdf

00242-kolnp-2003 correspondence.pdf

00242-kolnp-2003 description(complete).pdf

00242-kolnp-2003 drawings.pdf

00242-kolnp-2003 form-1.pdf

00242-kolnp-2003 form-13.pdf

00242-kolnp-2003 form-18.pdf

00242-kolnp-2003 form-2.pdf

00242-kolnp-2003 form-26.pdf

00242-kolnp-2003 form-3.pdf

00242-kolnp-2003 form-5.pdf

00242-kolnp-2003 form-6.pdf

00242-kolnp-2003 g.p.a.pdf

00242-kolnp-2003 letters patent.pdf

00242-kolnp-2003 priority document.pdf

242-KOLNP-2003-(16-01-2013)-CORRESPONDENCE.pdf

242-KOLNP-2003-(18-10-2012)-CORRESPONDENCE-1.pdf

242-KOLNP-2003-(18-10-2012)-CORRESPONDENCE.pdf

242-KOLNP-2003-(22-01-2013)-CORRESPONDENCE.pdf

242-KOLNP-2003-(25-10-2012)-CORRESPONDENCE.pdf

242-KOLNP-2003-FORM-27.pdf


Patent Number 212710
Indian Patent Application Number 242/KOLNP/2003
PG Journal Number 50/2007
Publication Date 14-Dec-2007
Grant Date 12-Dec-2007
Date of Filing 25-Feb-2003
Name of Patentee VERTEX PHARMACEUTICALS INCORPORATED
Applicant Address 130 WAVERLY STREET,CAMBRIDGE,MASSACHUSETTS 02139-4242
Inventors:
# Inventor's Name Inventor's Address
1 BABINE,ROBERT,EDWARD 19 CONCETTA WAY FRANKLIN,MA 02038
2 CHEN, SHU, HUI 13256 SNOW OWL DRIVE CARMEL, IN 46033
3 LAMAR, JASON, ERIC 1240 NORTH BROADWAY, APARTMENT 19 INDIANAPOLIS, IN 46202
4 SNYDER, NANCY, JUNE 3830 WEST 850 NORTH LIZTON, IN 46149
5 SUN, XICHENG, DAVID 923 GRAYS PEAK DRIVE SUPERIOR, CO 80027
6 TEBBE, MARK, JOSEPH VOLKADORFER WEG 32 D-22391 HAMBURG
7 VICTOR, FRANTZ, (NMN) 4855 NORTH TUXEDO STREET INDIANAPOLIS, IN 46205
8 GARCIA-PAREDES, CRISTINA, (NMN) C/ARROYO DE LA ELIPA 1, 4 DRCHA 28017 MADRID
9 PARKER, RAYMOND, SAMUEL, III 511 HAYFIELD COURT DOYLESTOWN, PA 18901
10 WANG, Q , MAY 12345 MOON RIVER COURT INDIANAPOLIS, IN 46236
11 YIP, IVONNE, YEE, MAI 1441 BADGER DRIVE INDIANAPOLIS, IN 46260
12 COLLADO, IVAN, (NMN) C/SANTA BARBARA 21, 2C 28220 MADRID
13 JIN, LING, (NMN) 3750 POWER DRIVE CARMEL, IN 46033
14 GUO, DEQI 5747 AQUA MARINE DRIVE CARMEL, IN 46033
15 GLASS, JOHN, IRVIN 625 BRYN MAWR DRIVE INDIANAPOLIS, IN 46260
PCT International Classification Number CO7D 403/00
PCT International Application Number PCT/US01/26008
PCT International Filing date 2001-08-31
PCT Conventions:
# PCT Application Number Date of Convention Priority Country
1 60/277,641 2001-03-21 U.S.A.
2 60/229,398 2000-08-31 U.S.A.